]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Mention incompatible change in comint-send-input.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.4 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 ---
163 ** If the environment variable DISPLAY specifies an unreachable X display,
164 Emacs will now startup as if invoked with the --no-window-system option.
165
166 +++
167 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
168 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
169 an interactively callable function.
170
171 +++
172 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
173 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
174 affects the initial frame.
175
176 +++
177 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
178 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
179 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
180 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
181 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
182
183 +++
184 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
185 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
186 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
187 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
188 `inhibit-splash-screen').
189
190 +++
191 ** The default is now to use a bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
192 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
193 the bitmap icon off.
194
195 +++
196 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
197 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
198 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
199
200 +++
201 ** Init file changes
202 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
203 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
204 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
205
206 +++
207 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
208 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
209 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
210 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
211 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
212 \f
213 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
214
215 +++
216 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
217 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
218 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
219 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
220
221 +++
222 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
223 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
224
225 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
226 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
227
228 +++
229 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
230 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
231 the operating system or your X server.
232
233 +++
234 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
235
236 +++
237 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
238 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
239 you about it.
240
241 +++
242 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
243 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
244
245 +++
246 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
247 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
248 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
249 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
250
251 +++
252 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
253 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
254
255 +++
256 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
257
258 See below under "incremental search changes".
259
260 ---
261 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
262
263 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
264 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
265 directory with Dired.
266
267 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
268 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
269
270 +++
271 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
272 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
273 it remains unchanged.
274
275 +++
276 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
277 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
278 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
279 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
280 "New keymaps for typing file names".
281
282 +++
283 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
284 M-o M-o requests refontification.
285
286 +++
287 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
288
289 See below for more details.
290
291 +++
292 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
293 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
294 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
295 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
296 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
297 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
298 \f
299 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
300
301 +++
302 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
303 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
304 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
305 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
306 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
307 a new Emacs.
308
309 +++
310 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
311 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
312
313 +++
314 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
315 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
316 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
317 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
318
319 +++
320 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
321
322 +++
323 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
324 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
325
326 ---
327 ** C-x 5 C-o displays a specified buffer in another frame
328 but does not switch to that frame. It's the multi-frame
329 analogue of C-x 4 C-o.
330
331 ---
332 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
333 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
334
335 +++
336 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
337 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
338
339 +++
340 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
341 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
342 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
343 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
344
345 +++
346 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
347 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
348 in Indented-Text mode.
349
350 +++
351 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
352
353 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
354 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
355 in the value, use `$$'.
356
357 +++
358 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
359 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
360 `same-window'.
361
362 +++
363 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
364 from the locale.
365
366 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
367 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
368 only faces matching this regexp.
369
370 ** Mark command changes:
371
372 +++
373 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
374 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
375 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
376
377 +++
378 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
379
380 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
381 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
382 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
383 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
384 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
385 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
386 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
387 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
388 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
389
390 +++
391 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
392
393 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
394 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
395 paragraphs.
396
397 +++
398 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
399 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
400 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
401 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
402 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
403 command only.
404
405 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
406 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
407 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
408 mark or the region.
409
410 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
411 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
412 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
413 C-g.
414
415 +++
416 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
417 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
418 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
419
420 ** Help command changes:
421
422 +++
423 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
424
425 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
426
427 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
428
429 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
430 that do not change:
431
432 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
433 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
434
435 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
436 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
437
438 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
439 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
440 run by the key sequence.
441 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
442 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
443 that command.
444
445 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
446 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
447 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
448 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
449 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
450 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
451 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
452 new-kill-line is on C-k
453
454 ---
455 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
456 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
457 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
458 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
459
460 +++
461 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
462 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
463
464 +++
465 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
466 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
467 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
468 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
469 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
470 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
471 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
472 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
473 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
474
475 +++
476 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
477 description various information about a character, including its
478 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
479 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
480 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
481
482 +++
483 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
484 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
485
486 +++
487 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
488 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
489 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
490 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
491 keyboard oriented alternative.
492
493 +++
494 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
495 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
496 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
497 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
498 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
499
500 +++
501 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
502 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
503 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
504 available.
505
506 +++
507 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
508 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
509 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
510 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
511 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
512 matching item.
513
514 ** Incremental Search changes:
515
516 +++
517 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
518 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
519 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
520 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
521 for details.
522
523 +++
524 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
525 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
526 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
527 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
528
529 +++
530 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
531 at the end of a line.
532
533 +++
534 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
535 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
536 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
537
538 +++
539 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
540 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
541 search string used as the string to replace.
542
543 +++
544 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
545 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
546 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
547
548 ** Replace command changes:
549
550 ---
551 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
552 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
553 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
554
555 +++
556 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
557 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
558 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
559 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
560 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
561 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
562 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
563 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
564 can be edited for each replacement.
565
566 +++
567 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
568 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
569
570 ---
571 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
572 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
573
574 ** File operation changes:
575
576 +++
577 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
578 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
579 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
580 is only rarely needed.
581
582 +++
583 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
584 suffix from every line before processing all the lines.
585
586 +++
587 *** If the local variables list contains any variable-value pairs that
588 are not known to be safe, Emacs shows a prompt asking whether to apply
589 the local variables list as a whole. In earlier versions, a prompt
590 was only issued for variables explicitly marked as risky (for the
591 definition of risky variables, see `risky-local-variable-p').
592
593 At the prompt, the user can choose to save the contents of this local
594 variables list to `safe-local-variable-values'. This new customizable
595 option is a list of variable-value pairs that are known to be safe.
596 Variables can also be marked as safe with the existing
597 `safe-local-variable' property (see `safe-local-variable-p').
598 However, risky variables will not be added to
599 `safe-local-variable-values' in this way.
600
601 +++
602 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
603 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
604
605 +++
606 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
607 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
608
609 +++
610 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
611
612 ---
613 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
614
615 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
616 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
617 directory with Dired.
618
619 +++
620 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
621 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
622 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
623 file.)
624
625 +++
626 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
627 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
628
629 +++
630 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
631 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
632 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
633 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
634 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
635 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
636
637 ---
638 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
639 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
640 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
641
642 ---
643 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
644 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
645 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
646
647 +++
648 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
649 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
650 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
651 in data loss, use with care.
652
653 +++
654 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
655 Emacs asks for confirmation.
656
657 +++
658 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
659
660 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
661 when visiting the file.
662
663 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
664 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
665 when saving the file.
666
667 +++
668 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
669 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
670 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
671 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
672 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
673 modes do.
674
675 ** Minibuffer changes:
676
677 +++
678 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
679 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
680
681 +++
682 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
683 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
684 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
685 prompt string.
686
687 ---
688 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
689
690 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
691 have in common and where they begin to differ.
692
693 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
694 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
695 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
696 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
697 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
698 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
699 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
700 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
701
702 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
703 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
704 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
705 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
706 its second argument.
707
708 +++
709 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
710 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
711 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
712 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
713 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
714 candidate is a directory.
715
716 +++
717 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
718 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
719 it remains unchanged.
720
721 +++
722 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
723 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
724 elements are deleted.
725
726 ** Redisplay changes:
727
728 +++
729 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
730 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
731 appears between the position information and the major mode.
732
733 +++
734 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
735
736 +++
737 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
738 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
739 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
740
741 +++
742 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
743 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
744 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
745 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
746
747 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
748 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
749 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
750 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
751 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
752 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
753
754 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
755 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
756
757 ---
758 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller than
759 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
760 vscroll property.
761
762 +++
763 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
764 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
765 the mode line of the currently selected window.
766
767 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
768 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
769
770 +++
771 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
772 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
773 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
774 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
775 set-fringe-style.
776
777 +++
778 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
779 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
780 the window can be scrolled.
781
782 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
783 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
784 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
785
786 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
787 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
788
789 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
790 position of each bitmap individually.
791
792 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
793 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
794 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
795 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
796
797 +++
798 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
799 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
800 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
801 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
802 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
803
804 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
805 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
806
807 +++
808 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
809 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
810 outside those margins.
811
812 +++
813 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
814 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
815
816 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
817 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
818 or when the frame is resized.
819
820 ** Cursor display changes:
821
822 +++
823 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
824 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
825
826 +++
827 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
828
829 +++
830 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
831 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
832 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
833 cursor does.
834
835 +++
836 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
837 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
838 appears in.
839
840 +++
841 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
842 of the recognized cursor types.
843
844 +++
845 *** On text terminals, the variable `visible-cursor' controls whether Emacs
846 uses the "very visible" cursor (the default) or the normal cursor.
847
848 ** New faces:
849
850 +++
851 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
852 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
853 areas.
854
855 *** `mode-line-buffer-id' is the standard face for buffer identification
856 parts of the mode line.
857
858 +++
859 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
860 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
861 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
862 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
863 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
864 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
865
866 +++
867 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
868
869 ** Font-Lock changes:
870
871 +++
872 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
873 M-o M-o requests refontification.
874
875 +++
876 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
877 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
878 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
879
880 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
881 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
882 `Info-mode-hook'.
883
884 +++
885 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
886 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
887 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
888 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
889 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
890
891 +++
892 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
893
894 +++
895 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
896
897 +++
898 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
899 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
900 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
901 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
902
903 ---
904 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
905 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
906 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
907 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
908 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
909
910 ---
911 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
912
913 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
914 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
915 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
916 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
917
918 ---
919 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
920
921 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
922 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
923 refontification takes place.
924
925 ** Menu support:
926
927 ---
928 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
929 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
930 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
931 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
932 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
933 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
934
935 ---
936 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
937
938 ---
939 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
940
941 ---
942 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
943 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
944 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
945
946 +++
947 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
948 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
949
950 ---
951 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
952 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
953
954 +++
955 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
956 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
957 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
958
959 ---
960 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
961 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
962
963 +++
964 *** For the Gtk+ version, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
965 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
966 the new dialog.
967
968 ** Mouse changes:
969
970 +++
971 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
972 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
973 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
974 can be selected only when it is active.
975
976 +++
977 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
978 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
979 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
980 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
981 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
982 to give it focus.
983
984 +++
985 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
986
987 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
988 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
989 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
990 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
991 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
992 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
993
994 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
995 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
996 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
997 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
998 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
999 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1000 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1001 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1002 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1003
1004 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1005 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1006 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1007 you release it).
1008
1009 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1010 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1011
1012 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1013 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1014
1015 +++
1016 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1017 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1018 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1019 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1020 also disable mouse highlighting.
1021
1022 +++
1023 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1024 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1025 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1026
1027 ---
1028 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1029 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1030
1031 ---
1032 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1033
1034 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1035 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1036 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1037 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1038
1039 +++
1040 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1041
1042 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1043
1044 ---
1045 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1046 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1047 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1048 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1049 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1050
1051 +++
1052 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1053 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1054 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1055 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1056 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1057 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1058 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1059 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1060
1061 +++
1062 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1063 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1064
1065 +++
1066 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1067 coding system.
1068
1069 +++
1070 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1071 of a file.
1072
1073 ---
1074 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1075 unicode.
1076
1077 +++
1078 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1079 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1080 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1081 command.
1082
1083 +++
1084 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1085 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1086
1087 +++
1088 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1089 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1090 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1091 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1092 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1093 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1094 mule-unicode-... ones.
1095
1096 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1097 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1098 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1099 possible.
1100
1101 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1102 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1103 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1104 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1105 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1106
1107 ---
1108 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1109 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1110 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1111 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1112
1113 ---
1114 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1115 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1116 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1117 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1118 automatically according to the locale.)
1119
1120 ---
1121 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1122 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1123 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1124 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1125 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1126 tamil-inscript.
1127
1128 ---
1129 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1130 characters.
1131
1132 ---
1133 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1134 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1135 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1136 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1137 M-f (forward-word)
1138 M-b (backward-word)
1139 M-d (kill-word)
1140 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1141 M-t (transpose-words)
1142 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1143
1144 ---
1145 *** Indian support has been updated.
1146 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1147 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1148 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1149 supported.
1150
1151 ---
1152 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1153
1154 ---
1155 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1156 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1157 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1158 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1159 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1160 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1161 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1162 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1163 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1164 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1165 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1166 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1167
1168 ---
1169 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1170 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1171 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1172
1173 ---
1174 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1175 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1176 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1177 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1178 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1179
1180 ---
1181 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1182 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1186 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1187 fontset appropriately.
1188
1189 ** Customize changes:
1190
1191 +++
1192 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1193 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1194 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1195 enable-theme to enable a disabled theme.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1199 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1200 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1201 faces.
1202
1203 ---
1204 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1205 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1206 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1207 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1208 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1209 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1210 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1211
1212 +++
1213 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1214 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1215 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1216 under the "[State]" button.
1217
1218 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1219
1220 +++
1221 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1222 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to T in Buffer Menu
1223 mode.
1224
1225 +++
1226 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1227 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1228 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1229
1230 ---
1231 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1232 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1233 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1234
1235 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1236 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1237 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1238 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1239 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1240
1241 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1242 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1243 t, and the status is shown.
1244
1245 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1246 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1247
1248 ** Dired mode:
1249
1250 ---
1251 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1252 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1253 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1254
1255 +++
1256 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1257 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1258
1259 +++
1260 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1261 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1262
1263 +++
1264 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1265 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1266 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1267 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1268 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1269 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1270
1271 +++
1272 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1273 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1274
1275 +++
1276 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1277
1278 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1279 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1280 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1281 instead.
1282
1283 +++
1284 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1285 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1286 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1287 directory listing into a buffer.
1288
1289 ** Comint changes:
1290
1291 ---
1292 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1293 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1294 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1295 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1296 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1297
1298 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1299 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1300
1301 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1302 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1303 lines, including any prompts.
1304
1305 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1306 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1307 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1308 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1309 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1310 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1311 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1312
1313 +++
1314 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1315 modes (shell-mode, etc.) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1316 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1317 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1318
1319 +++
1320 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1321 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1322 but declared obsolete.
1323
1324 ** M-x Compile changes:
1325
1326 ---
1327 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1328
1329 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1330 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1331 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1332 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1333
1334 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1335 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1336 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1337
1338 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1339 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1340 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1341 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1342 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1343
1344 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1345
1346 +++
1347 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1348 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1349 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1350 subprocesses inherit.
1351
1352 +++
1353 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1354 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1355
1356 +++
1357 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1358 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1359 in new face `next-error'.
1360
1361 +++
1362 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1363 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1364 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1365 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1366 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1367 C-c C-f.
1368
1369 +++
1370 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1371 the compilation buffer.
1372
1373 +++
1374 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1375 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1376 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1377 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1378 of the window.
1379
1380 ** Occur mode changes:
1381
1382 +++
1383 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1384 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1385 switching to it.
1386
1387 +++
1388 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1389 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1390
1391 +++
1392 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1393 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1394 `multi-occur-in-matching-buffers' which allows you to specify the
1395 buffers to search by their filenames or buffer names. Internally,
1396 Occur mode has been rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other
1397 changes.
1398
1399 ** Grep changes:
1400
1401 +++
1402 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1403
1404 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1405 customization group.
1406
1407 ---
1408 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1409
1410 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1411 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1412
1413 +++
1414 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1415 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1416
1417 ---
1418 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1419 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1420 settings, for grep commands only.
1421
1422 +++
1423 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlights matches in *grep*
1424 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1425 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1426 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1427 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1428 source line is highlighted.
1429
1430 +++
1431 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1432 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1433 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1434 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1435 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1436 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1437 file.
1438
1439 +++
1440 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1441 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1442 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1443 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1444 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1445 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1446
1447 ** X Windows Support:
1448
1449 +++
1450 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1451 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1452 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1453
1454 +++
1455 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1456 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1457 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1458 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1459 Meta and Alt:
1460 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1461 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1462
1463 +++
1464 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1465 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1466
1467 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1468 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1469
1470 ---
1471 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1472 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1473 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1474 and use the more appropriately result.
1475
1476 ---
1477 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1478 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1479 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1480
1481 ** Xterm support:
1482
1483 ---
1484 *** If you enable Xterm Mouse mode, Emacs will respond to mouse clicks
1485 on the mode line, header line and display margin, when run in an xterm.
1486
1487 ---
1488 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1489 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1490 following should work:
1491 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1492 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1493 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1494
1495 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1496
1497 +++
1498 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1499 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1500 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1501 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1502 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1503 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1504 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1505 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1506 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1507
1508 ---
1509 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1510 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1511 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1512 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1513 all of these colors.
1514
1515 +++
1516 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1517 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1518 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1519 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1520 colors as on X.
1521
1522 ---
1523 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1524 \f
1525 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1526
1527 ** ERC is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1528
1529 ERC is a powerful, modular, and extensible IRC client for Emacs.
1530
1531 To see what modules are available, type
1532 M-x customize-option erc-modules RET.
1533
1534 To start an IRC session, type M-x erc-select, and follow the prompts
1535 for server, port, and nick.
1536
1537 ---
1538 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1539
1540 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1541 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1542 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1543 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1544 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1545 separate buffers.
1546
1547 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1548 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1549
1550 ---
1551 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1552
1553 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1554 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1555 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1556 separate manual.
1557
1558 +++
1559 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1560 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1561
1562 +++
1563 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1564 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1565 program files that include other program files.
1566
1567 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1568 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1569 in them.
1570
1571 +++
1572 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1573
1574 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1575 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1576 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1577 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1578 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1579 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1580
1581 ---
1582 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1583 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1584
1585 ---
1586 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1587
1588 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1589 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1590 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1591 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1592
1593 +++
1594 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1595 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1596
1597 ---
1598 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1599
1600 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1601 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1602 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1603 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1604 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1605 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1606
1607 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1608 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1609 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1610 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1611
1612 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1613 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1614 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1615 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1616 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1617 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1618 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1619
1620 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1621 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1622 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1623
1624 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1625 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1626
1627 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1628 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1629 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1630 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1631
1632 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1633 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1634 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1635 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1636
1637 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1638 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1639 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1640 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1641
1642 +++
1643 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1644
1645 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1646 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1647 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1648 capabilities.
1649
1650 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1651 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1652
1653 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1654 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1655 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1656
1657 +++
1658 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1659 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1660 to increment the SOA serial.
1661
1662 ---
1663 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1664 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1665 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1666 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1667 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticeable. The display method can
1668 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1669
1670 +++
1671 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1672 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1673
1674 +++
1675 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1676 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1677 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1678 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1679 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1680
1681 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1682 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1683 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1684 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1685 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1686 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1687
1688 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1689 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1690 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1691 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1692 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1693 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1694 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1695 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1696 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1697 or local keymaps.
1698
1699 +++
1700 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1701 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1702
1703 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1704 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1705 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1706 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1707
1708 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1709 defined macros.
1710
1711 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1712 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1713 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1714 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1715 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1716 for more commands.
1717
1718 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1719 the keyboard macro ring.
1720
1721 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1722 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1723
1724 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1725 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1726 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1727 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1728
1729 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1730 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1731 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1732
1733 ---
1734 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1735 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1736 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1737
1738 +++
1739 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1740 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1741
1742 +++
1743 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1744 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1745 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1746 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1747 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1748 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1749 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1750 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1751 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1752
1753 +++
1754 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1755
1756 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1757 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1758 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1759 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1760 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1761 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1762
1763 ---
1764 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1765 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1766 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1767 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1768
1769 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1770
1771 ---
1772 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1773 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1774 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1775 settings.
1776
1777 +++
1778 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1779 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1780 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1781 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1782
1783 +++
1784 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1785 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1786
1787 +++
1788 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1789 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1790 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1791 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1792 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1793 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1794
1795 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1796 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1797 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1798
1799 +++
1800 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1801
1802 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1803 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1804 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1805 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1806 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1807 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1808 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1809 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1810 `rsync' to do the copying).
1811
1812 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1813 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1814
1815 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1816
1817 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1818
1819 Removing Tramp, and re-enabling Ange-FTP, can be achieved by M-x
1820 tramp-unload-tramp.
1821
1822 ---
1823 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1824
1825 ---
1826 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1827 configuration files.
1828
1829 +++
1830 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1831 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1832 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1833 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1834 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1835 recognized.
1836
1837 ---
1838 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1839
1840 +++
1841 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1842
1843 ---
1844 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1845 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1846
1847 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1848 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1849 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1850 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1851 boundaries during scrolling.
1852 \f
1853 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1854
1855 ** Changes in Dired
1856
1857 +++
1858 *** Bindings for Tumme added
1859 Several new keybindings, all starting with the C-t prefix, have been
1860 added to Dired. They are all bound to commands in Tumme. As a starting
1861 point, mark some image files in a dired buffer and do C-t d to display
1862 thumbnails of them in a separate buffer.
1863
1864 ** Changes in Hi Lock
1865
1866 +++
1867 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1868 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1869 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1870 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1871 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1872 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1873 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1874 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1875
1876 ** Changes in Allout
1877
1878 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1879 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1880 clear-text within a single file to your heart's content, using symmetric
1881 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1882 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1883 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1884 powerful ways.
1885
1886 *** Default command prefix changed to "\C-c " (control-c space), to avoid
1887 intruding on user's keybinding space. Customize the
1888 `allout-command-prefix' variable to your preference.
1889
1890 *** Allout now uses text overlay's `invisible' property (and others) for
1891 concealed text, instead of selective-display. This simplifies the code, in
1892 particularly avoiding the need for kludges for isearch dynamic-display,
1893 discretionary handling of edits of concealed text, undo concerns, etc.
1894
1895 *** Many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1896
1897 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1898 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1899 - refuse to create "containment discontinuities", where a
1900 topic is shifted deeper than the offspring-depth of its' container
1901 - bulleting variation is simpler and more accommodating, both in the
1902 default behavior and in ability to vary when creating new topics
1903 - many internal fixes and refinements
1904 - many module and function docstring clarifications
1905 - version number incremented to 2.2
1906
1907 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1908 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1909 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1910 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1911 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1912
1913 ---
1914 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1915
1916 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1917 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1918
1919 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1920 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1921 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1922
1923 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1924 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1925 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1926 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1927 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1928
1929 ---
1930 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
1931
1932 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
1933 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1934 faces.
1935
1936 +++
1937 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1938 of the file that precede the first header line.
1939
1940 +++
1941 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1942
1943 ---
1944 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1945 run most curses applications now.
1946
1947 +++
1948 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1949
1950 +++
1951 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1952 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1953 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1954
1955 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1956 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1957 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1958
1959 ---
1960 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1961 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1962
1963 ---
1964 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1965 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1966 incompatible change.
1967
1968 ---
1969 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1970
1971 +++
1972 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1973 resync points in both windows.
1974
1975 +++
1976 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1977
1978 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1979 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1980
1981 ---
1982 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1983 when Emacs visits them.
1984
1985 ** Info mode changes:
1986
1987 +++
1988 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1989 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1990
1991 +++
1992 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1993
1994 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1995 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1996 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1997 around the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1998 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1999 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
2000 Info node.
2001
2002 ---
2003 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
2004 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
2005 search without prompting for a new search string.
2006
2007 +++
2008 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
2009 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
2010 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
2011
2012 ---
2013 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
2014
2015 ---
2016 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
2017 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
2018
2019 +++
2020 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
2021 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
2022 possible matches.
2023
2024 ---
2025 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
2026 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
2027 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
2028
2029 +++
2030 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
2031 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
2032
2033 ---
2034 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
2035 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
2036
2037 +++
2038 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
2039
2040 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
2041 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
2042
2043 ---
2044 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
2045
2046 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
2047 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
2048 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
2049
2050 +++
2051 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
2052
2053 ---
2054 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
2055
2056 ** Lisp mode changes:
2057
2058 ---
2059 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2060
2061 +++
2062 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2063
2064 *** New features in evaluation commands
2065
2066 +++
2067 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2068 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2069
2070 +++
2071 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2072 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2073 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2074 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2075 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2076
2077 +++
2078 ** CC mode changes.
2079
2080 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2081 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2082 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2083
2084 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2085 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2086
2087 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2088 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2089
2090 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2091 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2092
2093 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2094 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2095 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2096 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2097 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2098
2099 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2100
2101 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2102
2103 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2104 position(s).
2105
2106 *** New Minor Modes
2107 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2108 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2109 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2110 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2111 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2112 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2113
2114 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2115 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2116 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2117
2118 *** New clean-ups
2119
2120 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2121 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2122 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2123
2124 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2125 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2126 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2127
2128 *** Font lock support.
2129 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2130 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2131 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2132 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2133 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2134 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2135
2136 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2137 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2138 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2139 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2140 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2141 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2142 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2143 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2144 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2145
2146 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2147 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2148 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2149 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2150 minute.
2151
2152 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2153 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2154 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2155 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2156 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2157 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2158
2159 **** Support for documentation comments.
2160 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2161 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2162 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2163 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2164
2165 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2166 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2167 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2168 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2169 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2170
2171 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2172 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2173 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2174 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2175 parens.
2176
2177 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2178 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2179 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2180 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2181 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2182
2183 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2184 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2185 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2186 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2187 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2188
2189 *** Support for the AWK language.
2190 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2191 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2192 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2193 Here is a summary:
2194
2195 **** Indentation Engine
2196 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2197
2198 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2199 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2200 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2201 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2202 definition, or structured statement.
2203
2204 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2205 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2206 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2207
2208 **** Font Locking
2209 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2210 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2211 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2212 the AWK language itself.
2213
2214 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2215 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2216 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2217 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2218 extended definition.
2219
2220 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2221 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2222 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2223 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2224
2225 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2226 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2227 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2228 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2229 composition-close, and incomposition.
2230
2231 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2232 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2233 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2234 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2235 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2236
2237 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2238
2239 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2240 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2241 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2242 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2243
2244 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2245 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2246
2247 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2248
2249 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2250 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2251 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2252 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2253
2254 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2255
2256 is now analyzed as
2257
2258 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2259
2260 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2261 symbol.
2262
2263 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2264 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2265 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2266 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2267 cdr.
2268
2269 *** API changes for derived modes.
2270
2271 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2272 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2273 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2274 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2275 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2276
2277 **** New language variable system.
2278 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2279 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2280
2281 **** New initialization functions.
2282 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2283 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2284 `c-init-language-vars'.
2285
2286 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2287 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2288 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2289 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2290
2291 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2292 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2293 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2294 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2295 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2296
2297 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2298 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2299 its substatement. E.g:
2300
2301 if (x)
2302 x_is_true:
2303 do_stuff();
2304
2305 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2306
2307 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2308 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2309 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2310 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2311 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2312 inside `#define's.
2313
2314 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2315
2316 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2317 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2318 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2319 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2320 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2321 empty lines within the macro better.
2322
2323 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2324 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2325 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2326
2327 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2328 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2329 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2330 backslashes can be moved.
2331
2332 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2333 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2334 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2335 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2336
2337 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2338 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2339 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2340 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2341 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2342 backslash) in the macro.
2343
2344 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2345 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2346 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2347 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2348 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2349 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2350
2351 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2352 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2353
2354 *** New lineup functions
2355
2356 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2357 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2358 continues. E.g:
2359
2360 result = prefix + "A message "
2361 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2362
2363 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2364 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2365
2366 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2367 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2368 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2369
2370 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2371 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2372
2373 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2374 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2375
2376 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2377 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2378 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2379 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2380 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2381 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2382
2383 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2384 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2385 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2386 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2387 context.
2388
2389 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2390 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2391 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2392 happen when macros are involved.
2393
2394 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2395 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2396 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2397 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2398 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2399 line is left untouched.
2400
2401 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2402 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2403 syntactic indentation.
2404
2405 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2406 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2407
2408 ---
2409 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2410
2411 ---
2412 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2413 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2414 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2415 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2416
2417 ** Fortran mode changes:
2418
2419 ---
2420 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2421 highlighting for the old default.
2422
2423 +++
2424 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2425 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2426 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2427
2428 +++
2429 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2430 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2431 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2432 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2433
2434 ---
2435 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2436 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2437 majority.
2438
2439 ---
2440 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2441 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2442
2443 ---
2444 ** Reftex mode changes
2445
2446 +++
2447 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2448
2449 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2450 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2451 support for multifile documents.
2452
2453 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2454 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2455 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2456 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2457 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2458 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2459 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2460 with the `d' key.
2461
2462 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2463 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2464
2465 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2466 key `M-%'.
2467
2468 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2469 location.
2470
2471 +++
2472 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2473
2474 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2475 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2476 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2477
2478 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2479 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2480 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2481 citation selection buffer.
2482
2483 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2484 cursor as a default search string.
2485
2486 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2487 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2488
2489 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2490 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2491
2492 Support for jurabib has been added.
2493
2494 +++
2495 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2496
2497 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2498 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2499
2500 +++
2501 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2502
2503 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2504 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2505 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2506 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2507 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2508 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2509
2510 +++
2511 *** Miscellaneous changes
2512
2513 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2514 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2515
2516 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2517
2518 +++
2519 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2520 to support use of font-lock.
2521
2522 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2523
2524 ---
2525 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2526 automatically.
2527
2528 +++
2529 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2530 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2531 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2532 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2533 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2534 from the file name or buffer contents.
2535
2536 +++
2537 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2538
2539 ** TeX modes:
2540
2541 +++
2542 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2543
2544 +++
2545 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2546 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2547 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2548 TeX commands to use at startup.
2549
2550 ---
2551 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2552 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2553
2554 +++
2555 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2556
2557 ** BibTeX mode:
2558
2559 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2560 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2561
2562 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2563 an existing BibTeX entry by inserting fields that may occur but are not
2564 present.
2565
2566 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2567
2568 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2569 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2570 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2571 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2572 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2573 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2574
2575 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2576 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2577
2578 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2579 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2580
2581 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2582 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2583
2584 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2585 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2586
2587 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2588 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2589 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2590
2591 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2592 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2593
2594 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2595 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2596
2597 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2598 in multiple BibTeX files.
2599
2600 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2601 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2602
2603 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2604 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2605 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2606
2607 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and
2608 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to
2609 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and
2610 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are
2611 still available as aliases.
2612
2613 +++
2614 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2615 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2616 and `C-c C-r'.
2617
2618 ** GUD changes:
2619
2620 +++
2621 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2622 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2623
2624 ---
2625 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2626 and other common debugger commands.
2627
2628 +++
2629 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2630 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2631 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2632 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2633 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2634 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2635 breakpoints.
2636
2637 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2638
2639 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2640 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2641 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2642
2643 +++
2644 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2645 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2646 not executing.
2647
2648 ---
2649 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2650
2651 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class information.
2652 Fast startup since there is no need to scan all source files up front.
2653 There is also no need to create and maintain lists of source
2654 directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath' and
2655 `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2656
2657 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2658 set/clear operations from Java source files under the classpath, stack
2659 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2660 (gud-finish).
2661
2662 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2663 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2664
2665 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2666 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2667 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2668
2669 *** Added Customization Variables
2670
2671 **** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2672
2673 **** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2674 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2675 java sources (previous method).
2676
2677 **** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for Java
2678 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2679 is nil).
2680
2681 *** Minor Improvements
2682
2683 **** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2684 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2685 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2686 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2687 `starttls' tool).
2688
2689 **** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2690
2691 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2692
2693 +++
2694 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2695
2696 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2697 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2698 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2699 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2700 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2701 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2702 be mode dependent.
2703
2704 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2705 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2706 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2707 toggles this mode.
2708
2709 +++
2710 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2711 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2712 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2713 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2714 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2715 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2716 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2717 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2718 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2719
2720 +++
2721 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2722 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2723 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2724 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2725 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2726
2727 ---
2728 ** recentf changes.
2729
2730 The recent file list is now automatically cleaned up when recentf mode is
2731 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2732 automatic cleanup.
2733
2734 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2735 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2736 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2737
2738 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2739 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2740 keep in the recent list.
2741
2742 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2743 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2744 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2745 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2746 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2747
2748 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2749 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2750 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2751
2752 +++
2753 ** Desktop package
2754
2755 +++
2756 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2757
2758 +++
2759 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2760
2761 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2762
2763 ---
2764 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2765 buffer list.
2766
2767 +++
2768 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2769 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2770 idle).
2771
2772 +++
2773 *** New commands:
2774 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2775 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2776 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2777 it was loaded.
2778 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2779 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2780
2781 ---
2782 *** New customizable variables:
2783 - desktop-save. Determines whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2784 killed.
2785 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2786 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2787 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2788 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2789 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2790 should not delete.
2791 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2792 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2793 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2794 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2795
2796 +++
2797 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2798
2799 ---
2800 *** New hooks:
2801 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2802 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2803
2804 ---
2805 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2806
2807 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2808 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2809 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2810 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2811 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2812 feature.
2813
2814 ** EDiff changes.
2815
2816 +++
2817 *** When comparing directories.
2818 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2819 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2820 from one directory to another.
2821
2822 +++
2823 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2824 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2825 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2826 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2827 comparison.
2828
2829 +++
2830 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2831 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2832 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2833
2834 +++
2835 ** Etags changes.
2836
2837 *** New regular expressions features
2838
2839 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2840
2841 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2842 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2843 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2844 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2845 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2846 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2847 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2848 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2849 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2850 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2851
2852 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2853
2854 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2855 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2856 CR, TAB, VT.
2857
2858 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2859
2860 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2861 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2862 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2863
2864 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2865
2866 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2867 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2868
2869 *** New language parsing features
2870
2871 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2872
2873 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2874
2875 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2876
2877 **** New language HTML.
2878
2879 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2880 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2881
2882 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2883
2884 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2885 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2886
2887 **** New language Lua.
2888
2889 All functions are tagged.
2890
2891 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2892
2893 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2894 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2895 package::sub.
2896
2897 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2898
2899 **** New language PHP.
2900
2901 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2902 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2903
2904 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2905
2906 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2907 renewenvironment.
2908
2909 *** Honor #line directives.
2910
2911 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2912 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2913 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2914 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2915 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2916
2917 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2918
2919 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2920 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2921 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2922 the file FILE.
2923
2924 ** VC Changes
2925
2926 +++
2927 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2928 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2929
2930 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2931 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2932 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2933 `.emacs' file:
2934
2935 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2936
2937 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2938
2939 +++
2940 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2941 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2942
2943 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2944 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2945 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2946
2947 +++
2948 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2949
2950 +++
2951 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2952
2953 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2954 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2955 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2956
2957 P: annotates the previous revision
2958 N: annotates the next revision
2959 J: annotates the revision at line
2960 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2961 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2962 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2963 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2964
2965 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2966
2967 +++
2968 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2969 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2970 in the repository.
2971
2972 +++
2973 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2974 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2975 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2976 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2977
2978 +++
2979 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2980 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2981 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2982
2983 +++
2984 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2985
2986 See the documentation of the user option
2987 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2988
2989 ** Rmail changes:
2990
2991 ---
2992 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2993
2994 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2995 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2996 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2997
2998 +++
2999 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
3000
3001 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
3002 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
3003 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
3004 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
3005 used instead of the native one.
3006
3007 ** Gnus package
3008
3009 ---
3010 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
3011
3012 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
3013 PGP/MIME.
3014
3015 ---
3016 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
3017
3018 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
3019
3020 ---
3021 ** MH-E changes.
3022
3023 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.93. There have been major changes since
3024 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
3025
3026 ** Calendar changes:
3027
3028 +++
3029 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
3030 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
3031
3032 +++
3033 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
3034 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
3035
3036 +++
3037 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
3038 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
3039 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
3040 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
3041 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
3042 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
3043 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
3044 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
3045 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
3046
3047 +++
3048 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
3049 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
3050 count backward from the end of the year.
3051
3052 +++
3053 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
3054 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
3055 day of that ISO week.
3056
3057 ---
3058 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
3059 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
3060
3061 ---
3062 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
3063 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
3064 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
3065 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3066
3067 ---
3068 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3069 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3070 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3071
3072 +++
3073 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3074 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3075 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3076 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3077
3078 +++
3079 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3080 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3081 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3082 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3083 formats.
3084
3085 +++
3086 ** Speedbar changes:
3087
3088 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3089 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3090
3091 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3092 keymap.
3093
3094 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3095 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3096
3097 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3098
3099 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3100 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3101 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3102 its descendents.
3103
3104 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3105 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3106 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3107 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3108 deletion.
3109
3110 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3111 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3112 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3113 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3114 that number to `other-frame'.
3115
3116 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3117 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3118
3119 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3120 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3121 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3122 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3123 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3124 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3125 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3126 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3127 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3128
3129 ---
3130 ** sql changes.
3131
3132 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlighting of different
3133 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3134 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3135 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3136 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3137
3138 The following values are supported:
3139
3140 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3141 db2 DB2
3142 informix Informix
3143 ingres Ingres
3144 interbase Interbase
3145 linter Linter
3146 ms Microsoft
3147 mysql MySQL
3148 oracle Oracle
3149 postgres Postgres
3150 solid Solid
3151 sqlite SQLite
3152 sybase Sybase
3153
3154 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3155 SQL mode indicator.
3156
3157 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3158 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3159 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3160
3161 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3162
3163 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3164 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3165 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3166 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3167
3168 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3169 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3170
3171 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3172
3173 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3174 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3175
3176 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3177
3178 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3179 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3180 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3181 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3182 terminated.
3183
3184 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3185 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3186 credentials to authenticate the user.
3187
3188 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3189 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3190 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3191
3192 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3193 Keyword highlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3194
3195 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3196 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3197 defaults.
3198
3199 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3200 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3201 `sql-product'.
3202
3203 ---
3204 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3205
3206 ** FFAP changes:
3207
3208 +++
3209 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3210
3211 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3212 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3213 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3214 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3215
3216 ---
3217 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3218
3219 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3220 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3221
3222 ---
3223 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3224
3225 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3226 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3227 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3228 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3229 with other details of skeleton construction.
3230
3231 ---
3232 ** Hideshow mode changes
3233
3234 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3235 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3236 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3237 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3238
3239 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3240 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3241 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3242
3243 +++
3244 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3245 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3246 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3247
3248 ---
3249 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3250
3251 ---
3252 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3253 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3254 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3255 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3256
3257 ---
3258 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3259
3260 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3261 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3262 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3263
3264 ---
3265 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3266 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3267 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3268 using strokes as an input method.
3269
3270 ** Emacs server changes:
3271
3272 +++
3273 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3274
3275 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3276 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3277 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3278 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3279
3280 +++
3281 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3282 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3283 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3284
3285 +++
3286 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3287
3288 ---
3289 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3290
3291 +++
3292 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3293
3294 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3295 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3296 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3297
3298 ---
3299 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3300 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3301
3302 ---
3303 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3304
3305 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3306 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3307 inverse-video.
3308
3309 ---
3310 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3311
3312 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3313 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3314 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3315
3316 ** battery.el changes:
3317
3318 ---
3319 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3320
3321 ---
3322 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3323
3324 ---
3325 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3326
3327 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3328 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3329 byte boundaries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3330 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3331
3332 ---
3333 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3334
3335 ---
3336 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3337
3338 ---
3339 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3340 \f
3341 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3342
3343 +++
3344 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3345
3346 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3347 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3348 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3349 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3350 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3351 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3352 where USERNAME is your user name.
3353
3354 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3355 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3356 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3357
3358 +++
3359 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3360
3361 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3362 existing values. For example:
3363
3364 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3365
3366 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3367 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3368
3369 ---
3370 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3371
3372 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3373 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3374
3375 ---
3376 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3377
3378 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3379
3380 ---
3381 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3382
3383 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3384 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3385 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3386 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3387 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3388 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3389
3390 ---
3391 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3392
3393 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3394 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3395 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3396 sound support for those formats.
3397
3398 ---
3399 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3400
3401 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3402
3403 ---
3404 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3405
3406 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3407 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3408 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3409
3410 ---
3411 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3412
3413 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3414 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3415 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3416 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3417 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3418 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3419 you wish to use them in other faces.
3420
3421 ---
3422 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3423
3424 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3425 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3426 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3427 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3428 any customizations.
3429
3430 ---
3431 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3432
3433 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3434 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3435 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3436 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favors local console
3437 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3438 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3439 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3440 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3441 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3442 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3443
3444 ---
3445 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3446
3447 ---
3448 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3449 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3450 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3451
3452 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3453 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3454 \f
3455 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3456
3457 ---
3458 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3459 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3460
3461 +++
3462 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3463 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3464 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3465 `undefined'.)
3466
3467 +++
3468 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3469 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3470 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3471
3472 ---
3473 The function `comint-send-input' now accepts 3 optional arguments:
3474
3475 (comint-send-input &optional no-newline artificial)
3476
3477 Callers sending input not from the user should use bind the 3rd
3478 argument `artificial' to a non-nil value, to prevent Emacs from
3479 deleting the part of subprocess output that matches the input.
3480
3481 ---
3482 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3483
3484 +++
3485 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3486 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3487 \f
3488 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3489
3490 ** General Lisp changes:
3491
3492 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3493 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3494 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3495
3496 +++
3497 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3498
3499 +++
3500 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3501
3502 +++
3503 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3504
3505 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3506 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3507 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3508
3509 +++
3510 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3511 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3512
3513 +++
3514 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3515
3516 It recursively copies through both CARs and CDRs.
3517
3518 +++
3519 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3520
3521 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3522 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3523 first one.
3524
3525 +++
3526 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3527
3528 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3529 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3530
3531 +++
3532 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3533
3534 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3535 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3536 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3537 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3538
3539 +++
3540 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3541
3542 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3543
3544 +++
3545 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3546
3547 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3548 longer accepted.
3549
3550 +++
3551 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3552
3553 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3554 cyclic.
3555
3556 +++
3557 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3558
3559 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3560 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3561
3562 +++
3563 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3564
3565 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3566 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3567 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3568
3569 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3570 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3571
3572 +++
3573 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3574
3575 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3576 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3577 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3578
3579 +++
3580 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3581
3582 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3583 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3584 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3585
3586 +++
3587 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3588
3589 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3590 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3591 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3592 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3593
3594 +++
3595 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3596
3597 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3598 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3599 the code that has inhibited quitting exits.
3600
3601 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3602 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3603
3604 +++
3605 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3606
3607 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3608
3609 +++
3610 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3611
3612 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3613 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3614 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc.).
3615
3616 +++
3617 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3618 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3619 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3620
3621 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3622
3623 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3624
3625 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3626
3627 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3628
3629 +++
3630 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3631
3632 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3633 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3634
3635 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3636
3637 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3638 possible declaration specifiers are:
3639
3640 (indent INDENT)
3641 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3642
3643 (edebug DEBUG)
3644 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3645 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3646 but this is cleaner.)
3647
3648 ---
3649 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3650
3651 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3652
3653 ---
3654 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3655
3656 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3657 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3658 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3659 forms.
3660
3661 +++
3662 ** Variable aliases:
3663
3664 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3665
3666 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3667 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3668 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3669 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3670
3671 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3672 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3673
3674 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3675
3676 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3677 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3678 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3679
3680 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3681 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3682
3683 +++
3684 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3685 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3686
3687 ** defcustom changes:
3688
3689 +++
3690 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3691
3692 ** String changes:
3693
3694 +++
3695 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3696
3697 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3698 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3699 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3700
3701 +++
3702 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3703
3704 +++
3705 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3706
3707 +++
3708 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3709 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3710 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3711 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3712 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3713
3714 +++
3715 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3716 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3717
3718 +++
3719 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3720 text properties.
3721
3722 +++
3723 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3724 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3725 been declared obsolete.
3726
3727 +++
3728 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3729
3730 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3731 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3732 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3733 warnings in a separate window.
3734
3735 +++
3736 ** Progress reporters.
3737
3738 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3739 progress messages for the user.
3740
3741 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3742 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3743 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3744
3745 ** Buffer positions:
3746
3747 +++
3748 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3749 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3750 the usable window height and width is used.
3751
3752 +++
3753 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3754 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3755 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3756 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3757 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3758
3759 +++
3760 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3761
3762 It defaults to 1.
3763
3764 +++
3765 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3766
3767 It defaults to 1.
3768
3769 +++
3770 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' tests if a position is in a clickable link.
3771
3772 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3773 functionality.
3774
3775 +++
3776 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3777
3778 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3779
3780 +++
3781 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3782
3783 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3784 give up and return LIMIT.
3785
3786 +++
3787 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3788 and partial visibility state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3789 arg is non-nil.
3790
3791 +++
3792 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3793 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3794 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3795
3796 ** Text modification:
3797
3798 +++
3799 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3800 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3801 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3802
3803 +++
3804 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3805 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3806 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3807
3808 +++
3809 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3810 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3811 inserted substring.
3812
3813 +++
3814 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3815 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3816 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3817 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3818 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3819
3820 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3821 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3822 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3823 text.
3824
3825 +++
3826 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3827 argument.
3828
3829 +++
3830 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3831 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3832 be inserted is translated through it.
3833
3834 ---
3835 *** Text clones.
3836
3837 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3838 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3839 clone to the other.
3840
3841 ---
3842 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3843
3844 ** Filling changes.
3845
3846 +++
3847 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3848 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3849 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3850
3851 +++
3852 ** Atomic change groups.
3853
3854 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3855 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3856 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3857
3858 (atomic-change-group
3859 (insert foo)
3860 (delete-region x y))
3861
3862 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3863 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3864 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3865 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3866
3867 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3868 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3869
3870 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3871 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3872 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3873 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3874
3875 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3876 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3877 do this.
3878
3879 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3880 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3881 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3882 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3883
3884 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3885 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3886 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3887 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3888 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3889 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3890 twice.
3891
3892 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3893 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3894 returned values, like this:
3895
3896 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3897 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3898
3899 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3900 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3901 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3902
3903 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3904 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3905 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3906 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3907 finished.
3908
3909 ** Buffer-related changes:
3910
3911 ---
3912 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3913
3914 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3915
3916 +++
3917 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3918
3919 +++
3920 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3921 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3922 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3923 value of VARIABLE instead.
3924
3925 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3926 various status records in parallel.
3927
3928 It takes a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3929 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3930 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3931 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3932 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3933 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3934 it returns nil.
3935
3936 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3937 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3938 vector into the variable and returns t.
3939
3940 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3941 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3942 purpose.
3943
3944 +++
3945 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3946 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3947 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3948 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3949
3950 ** Local variables lists:
3951
3952 +++
3953 *** Text properties in local variables.
3954
3955 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3956 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3957
3958 +++
3959 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3960 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3961 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3962 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3963 needed.
3964
3965 ---
3966 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3967 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3968 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3969 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3970 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3971 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3972
3973 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3974 confirmation as before.
3975
3976 ** Searching and matching changes:
3977
3978 +++
3979 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3980 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3981 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3982
3983 +++
3984 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3985 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3986 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3987 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3988
3989 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3990 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3991
3992 +++
3993 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3994
3995 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3996 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3997 specified by the syntax table.
3998
3999 ---
4000 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
4001
4002 +++
4003 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
4004 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
4005 characters and ranges.
4006
4007 ---
4008 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4009 properties from surrounding text.
4010
4011 +++
4012 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4013 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4014 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4015
4016 +++
4017 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
4018 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
4019 passed to these functions will be reseated to point to nowhere.
4020
4021 +++
4022 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
4023 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
4024 that end a sentence without following spaces.
4025
4026 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
4027 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
4028 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
4029 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
4030 `sentence-end-without-space'.
4031
4032 ** Undo changes:
4033
4034 +++
4035 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
4036
4037 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
4038 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
4039 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
4040
4041 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
4042 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
4043 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
4044
4045 +++
4046 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
4047 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
4048 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
4049
4050 +++
4051 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
4052 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
4053
4054 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
4055 elements with the following format:
4056 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
4057
4058 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
4059 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
4060 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
4061 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
4062
4063 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
4064 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
4065 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4066 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4067 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4068 rectangle.
4069 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4070 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4071 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4072 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4073 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4074 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4075 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4076 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4077
4078 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4079 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4080 the killed text.
4081
4082 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4083 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4084 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4085 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4086 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4087
4088 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4089 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4090 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4091 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4092
4093 ** Syntax table changes:
4094
4095 +++
4096 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4097
4098 +++
4099 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4100 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4101 of text properties as well as the character code.
4102
4103 +++
4104 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4105 by `syntax-after').
4106
4107 +++
4108 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' provides an efficient way to find the
4109 current syntactic context at point.
4110
4111 ** File operation changes:
4112
4113 +++
4114 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4115 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4116
4117 +++
4118 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4119 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4120 operation.
4121
4122 +++
4123 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4124 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4125 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4126 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4127
4128 +++
4129 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4130 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4131
4132 +++
4133 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4134 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4135 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4136
4137 +++
4138 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4139
4140 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4141
4142 +++
4143 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4144 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4145
4146 +++
4147 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4148 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4149 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4150 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4151
4152 +++
4153 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4154 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4155 tasks. For example, it can be used by the copyright package to make
4156 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4157
4158 +++
4159 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4160 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4161 it's modified).
4162
4163 +++
4164 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4165 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4166 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4167 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4168 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4169 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4170 further filter candidate files.
4171
4172 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4173 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4174 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependencies.
4175
4176 ---
4177 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4178
4179 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4180 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4181 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4182 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4183 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4184
4185 +++
4186 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4187
4188 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4189 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4190 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4191 operations.
4192
4193 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4194 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4195
4196 +++
4197 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4198 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4199
4200 ** Input changes:
4201
4202 +++
4203 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4204 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4205 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4206
4207 +++
4208 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4209 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4210 it returns just the directory name.
4211
4212 ---
4213 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4214 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4215 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4216
4217 +++
4218 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4219 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4220 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4221 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4222 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4223
4224 ** Minibuffer changes:
4225
4226 +++
4227 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4228 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4229 defaults to the current buffer.
4230
4231 +++
4232 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4233 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4234
4235 +++
4236 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4237 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4238
4239 +++
4240 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4241 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The
4242 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4243 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4244 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4245
4246 ---
4247 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4248 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4249
4250 +++
4251 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4252 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4253 `read-file-name' function.
4254
4255 +++
4256 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4257
4258 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4259 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4260
4261 ** Completion changes:
4262
4263 +++
4264 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4265 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4266 operate on.
4267
4268 +++
4269 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4270 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4271 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4272 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4273 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4274
4275 +++
4276 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4277 as a dynamic completion table.
4278
4279 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4280
4281 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4282 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4283 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4284 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4285 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4286 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4287
4288 +++
4289 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4290 as a lazy completion table.
4291
4292 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4293
4294 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4295 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4296 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4297 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4298 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4299 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4300
4301 +++
4302 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4303
4304 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4305
4306 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4307 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4308 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4309 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4310 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4311 the spaces).
4312
4313 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4314
4315 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4316 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4317 example,
4318
4319 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4320
4321 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4322
4323 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4324 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4325 binding and lookup functionality.
4326
4327 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4328 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4329 original command.
4330
4331 Example:
4332 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4333 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4334 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4335 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4336 `kill-word'.
4337
4338 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4339 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4340 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4341
4342 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4343 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4344
4345 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4346 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4347
4348 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4349 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4350 runs `my-kill-line'.
4351
4352 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4353
4354 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4355 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4356 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4357 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4358
4359 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4360 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4361
4362 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4363 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4364
4365 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4366 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4367 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4368 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4369 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4370 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4371
4372 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4373 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4374 command was not remapped.
4375
4376 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4377 over minor mode keymaps.
4378
4379 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4380 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4381 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4382
4383 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4384
4385 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4386 bindings of the parent keymap.
4387
4388 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4389
4390 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4391 active keymaps.
4392
4393 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4394 defined keys and their definitions.
4395
4396 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4397
4398 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4399 in the keymap.
4400
4401 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4402
4403 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4404 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4405 keymap alist to this list.
4406
4407 ** Abbrev changes:
4408
4409 +++
4410 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4411
4412 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4413
4414 +++
4415 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4416
4417 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4418 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4419 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4420 specify this flag.
4421
4422 +++
4423 ** Enhancements to process support
4424
4425 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4426 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4427
4428 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4429
4430 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4431 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4432 functions.
4433
4434 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4435 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4436
4437 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4438 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4439
4440 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4441 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4442 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4443 entire property list of a process.
4444
4445 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4446 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4447 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4448 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4449 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4450 speech synthesis.
4451
4452 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4453
4454 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4455 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4456 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4457 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4458 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4459 from such processes, allowing them to produce more output before
4460 emacs tries to read it.
4461
4462 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4463
4464 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4465
4466 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4467 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4468 `default-directory'.
4469
4470 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4471 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4472
4473 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4474 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4475 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4476
4477 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4478 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4479
4480 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4481 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4482
4483 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4484 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4485 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4486 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4487 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4488
4489 +++
4490 ** Enhanced networking support.
4491
4492 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4493 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4494 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4495
4496 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4497 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4498 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4499 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4500 - IPv6 is supported (when available). You may explicitly select IPv6
4501 using :family 'ipv6 arg.
4502 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4503 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4504 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4505 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4506
4507 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4508 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4509 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:family ipv6))
4510
4511 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4512
4513 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4514
4515 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4516 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4517
4518 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4519
4520 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4521 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4522 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4523 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4524 string for other formatting options.
4525
4526 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4527
4528 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4529 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4530 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4531
4532 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4533 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4534
4535 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4536
4537 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4538 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4539 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4540 stopped state.
4541
4542 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4543
4544 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4545 current network addresses.
4546
4547 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4548
4549 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4550 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4551
4552 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4553
4554 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4555 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4556 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4557 "connection broken by remote peer".
4558
4559 ** Using window objects:
4560
4561 +++
4562 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4563
4564 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4565 header line.
4566
4567 +++
4568 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4569
4570 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4571 or the header line.
4572
4573 +++
4574 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4575
4576 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4577 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4578 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4579 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4580 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4581
4582 +++
4583 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4584 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4585 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4586 the mode line.
4587
4588 +++
4589 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4590 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4591
4592 +++
4593 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4594 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4595 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4596
4597 +++
4598 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4599
4600 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4601
4602 +++
4603 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4604 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4605 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4606 buffer.
4607
4608 +++
4609 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4610
4611 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4612 and scroll-bar settings.
4613
4614 +++
4615 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4616
4617 +++
4618 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4619 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4620 dedicated windows.
4621
4622 +++
4623 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4624 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4625
4626 +++
4627 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4628
4629 *** New buffer-local variables `fringe-indicator-alist' and
4630 `fringe-cursor-alist' maps between logical (internal) fringe indicator
4631 and cursor symbols and the actual fringe bitmaps to be displayed.
4632 This decouples the logical meaning of the fringe indicators from the
4633 physical appearance, as well as allowing different fringe bitmaps to
4634 be used in different windows showing different buffers.
4635
4636 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4637 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4638
4639 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4640 identifying the bitmap such as `left-truncation' or `continued-line'.
4641
4642 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4643 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4644
4645 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4646 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4647 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4648 foreground color of the bitmap.
4649
4650 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4651 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4652 bitmap of the display line.
4653
4654 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4655 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4656 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4657 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4658 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4659
4660 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4661 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4662
4663 ** Other window fringe features:
4664
4665 +++
4666 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4667
4668 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4669 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4670 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4671 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4672
4673 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4674 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4675 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4676 between the left and right fringe. To force a specific fringe width,
4677 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4678 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4679
4680 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4681 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4682 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4683 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4684
4685 +++
4686 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4687
4688 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4689 position settings.
4690
4691 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4692 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4693 `set-window-fringes'.
4694
4695 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4696 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4697 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4698 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4699
4700 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4701 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4702 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4703 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4704 an update of the display margins.
4705
4706 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4707 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4708
4709 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4710 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4711 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4712 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4713 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4714 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4715 of the display margins.
4716
4717 ** Redisplay features:
4718
4719 +++
4720 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4721
4722 +++
4723 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4724 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4725 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4726 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4727 forcing an explicit window update.
4728
4729 +++
4730 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4731 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4732 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4733
4734 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4735 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4736
4737 +++
4738 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4739 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4740
4741 It contains a list of variables which contain overlay arrow position
4742 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4743
4744 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4745 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4746 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4747 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4748 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4749 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4750
4751 +++
4752 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4753
4754 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4755 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4756
4757 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4758 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4759 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4760 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4761 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4762
4763 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4764 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4765 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4766
4767 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4768 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4769 the given value.
4770
4771 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4772 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4773 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4774
4775 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4776 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4777
4778 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4779 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4780 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4781 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4782 exactly that many pixels high.
4783
4784 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4785 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4786 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4787 the `line-spacing' variable.
4788
4789 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4790 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4791
4792 +++
4793 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4794 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4795
4796 +++
4797 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4798
4799 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4800 PROPS is a property list, now allows pixel based width and height
4801 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4802
4803 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4804 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4805 are supported:
4806
4807 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4808 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4809 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4810 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4811 | scroll-bar | text
4812 POS ::= left | center | right
4813 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4814 OP ::= + | -
4815
4816 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4817 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4818 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4819 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4820 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4821 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4822 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4823 the image.
4824
4825 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4826 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4827 corresponding area of the window.
4828
4829 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4830 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4831 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4832 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4833 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4834 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4835 these symbols), further occurrences of these symbols are interpreted as
4836 the width of the area.
4837
4838 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4839 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4840
4841 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4842 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4843 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4844
4845 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4846 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4847 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4848 height) of the specified image.
4849
4850 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4851 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4852
4853 +++
4854 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4855 text property string that may be present at the current window
4856 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4857 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4858
4859 +++
4860 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4861 supported on text terminals.
4862
4863 +++
4864 *** Support for displaying image slices
4865
4866 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4867 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4868
4869 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4870 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4871
4872 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4873 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4874
4875 +++
4876 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4877
4878 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4879 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4880 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4881 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4882 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4883 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4884 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4885 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4886
4887 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4888 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4889 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4890 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4891 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4892 for possible pointer shapes.
4893
4894 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4895 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4896 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4897
4898 +++
4899 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4900 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4901 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4902 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4903 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4904 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4905 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4906
4907 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4908
4909 Note that all images formerly located in the lisp directory have been
4910 moved to etc/images.
4911
4912 +++
4913 *** New function `image-load-path-for-library' returns a suitable
4914 search path for images relative to library. This function is useful in
4915 external packages to save users from having to update
4916 `image-load-path'.
4917
4918 +++
4919 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4920 images that Emacs will load and display.
4921
4922 ** Mouse pointer features:
4923
4924 +++ (lispref)
4925 ??? (man)
4926 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4927 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4928 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4929 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4930 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4931
4932 +++
4933 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4934 :pointer image property.
4935
4936 +++
4937 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4938 controlled/overridden via the `pointer' text property.
4939
4940 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4941
4942 +++
4943 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4944 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4945
4946 +++
4947 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4948 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4949 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4950
4951 +++
4952 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4953
4954 +++
4955 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4956
4957 +++
4958 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4959 text area).
4960
4961 +++
4962 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4963 and all areas.
4964
4965 +++
4966 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4967 of the mouse event position.
4968
4969 +++
4970 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4971
4972 +++
4973 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4974 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4975
4976 +++
4977 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4978 (image or character) clicked on.
4979
4980 +++
4981 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4982
4983 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4984 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4985 the total width and height of that object.
4986
4987 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4988
4989 +++
4990 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4991 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4992
4993 +++
4994 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4995
4996 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4997 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4998 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4999 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
5000
5001 +++
5002 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
5003 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
5004 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
5005 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
5006 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
5007
5008 +++
5009 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
5010
5011 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
5012 property names as argument rather than a property list.
5013
5014 ** Face changes
5015
5016 +++
5017 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
5018 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
5019 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
5020 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
5021 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
5022 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
5023
5024 +++
5025 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
5026 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
5027
5028 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
5029 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
5030 defined with `defface'.
5031
5032 ---
5033 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
5034 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
5035 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
5036 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
5037 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
5038
5039 +++
5040 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
5041 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
5042 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
5043 by them).
5044
5045 +++
5046 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
5047 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
5048 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
5049 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
5050 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
5051
5052 ---
5053 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
5054 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
5055 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
5056
5057 +++
5058 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
5059
5060 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
5061 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
5062 attribute.
5063
5064 +++
5065 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
5066 help with handling relative face attributes.
5067
5068 +++
5069 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
5070
5071 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
5072 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
5073 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
5074 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
5075 `face' properties.
5076
5077 ---
5078 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
5079 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
5080 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
5081 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
5082 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
5083
5084 ---
5085 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
5086 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
5087
5088 ** Font-Lock changes:
5089
5090 +++
5091 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
5092
5093 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5094 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5095 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5096 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5097
5098 +++
5099 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5100
5101 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5102 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5103 properties than `face'.
5104
5105 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5106 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5107
5108 ---
5109 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5110
5111 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5112 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5113 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5114 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5115 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5116
5117 s{
5118 foo
5119 }{
5120 bar
5121 }e
5122
5123 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5124 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5125 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5126 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5127
5128 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5129
5130 +++
5131 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5132 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5133 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5134 variable `magic-mode-alist'.
5135
5136 +++
5137 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5138
5139 +++
5140 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5141 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5142 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5143
5144 ---
5145 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5146 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5147 it in that buffer.
5148
5149 +++
5150 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5151 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5152 the language.
5153
5154 +++
5155 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5156 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5157
5158 +++
5159 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5160 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5161 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5162
5163 ** Minor mode changes:
5164
5165 +++
5166 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5167 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5168
5169 +++
5170 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5171
5172 +++
5173 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5174
5175 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5176 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5177
5178 ** Command loop changes:
5179
5180 +++
5181 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5182 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5183 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5184
5185 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5186 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5187
5188 +++
5189 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5190
5191 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5192 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5193 macros.
5194
5195 +++
5196 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5197 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5198 covered by an image or composition property.
5199
5200 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5201 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5202 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5203 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5204 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5205
5206 +++
5207 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5208 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5209 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5210 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5211 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5212
5213 +++
5214 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5215 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5216 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5217
5218 +++
5219 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5220 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5221
5222 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5223
5224 +++
5225 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5226 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5227 current file redefined it).
5228
5229 +++
5230 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5231 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5232
5233 +++
5234 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5235 variable or face definitions.
5236
5237 +++
5238 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5239 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5240 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5241
5242 ---
5243 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5244 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5245 than 3 levels of nesting.
5246
5247 +++
5248 ** Byte compiler changes:
5249
5250 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5251 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5252 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5253 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5254 compilation output buffer.
5255
5256 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5257 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5258
5259 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5260 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5261 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5262 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5263 forms:
5264
5265 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5266 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5267
5268 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5269 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5270 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5271 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5272 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5273 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5274
5275 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5276 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5277 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5278 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5279 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5280 you anything.
5281
5282 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5283
5284 ---
5285 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5286 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5287 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5288
5289 ** Frame operations:
5290
5291 +++
5292 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5293
5294 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5295 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5296
5297 +++
5298 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5299 for all (existing and future) frames.
5300
5301 +++
5302 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5303 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5304 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5305 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5306
5307 +++
5308 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5309 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5310
5311 ** Mule changes:
5312
5313 +++
5314 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5315
5316 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5317 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5318 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5319 now:
5320
5321 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5322
5323 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5324 the time it takes to convert the format.
5325
5326 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5327 wasteful.
5328
5329 ---
5330 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5331 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5332
5333 +++
5334 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5335 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5336 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5337 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5338
5339 ---
5340 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5341 of one coding system from another coding system.
5342
5343 ---
5344 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5345 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5346 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5347
5348 +++
5349 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5350 it is read from a file without decoding.
5351
5352 ---
5353 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5354 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5355
5356 ---
5357 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5358 current input method to input a character.
5359
5360 ** Mode line changes:
5361
5362 +++
5363 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5364
5365 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5366 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5367
5368 +++
5369 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5370 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5371
5372 +++
5373 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5374 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5375 line.
5376
5377 +++
5378 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5379
5380 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5381
5382 ---
5383 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5384 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5385 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5386 several versions ago.
5387
5388 ---
5389 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5390 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5391 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5392
5393 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5394 made with easy-menu.
5395
5396 ---
5397 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5398 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5399 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5400 need to have a name.
5401
5402 ** Operating system access:
5403
5404 +++
5405 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5406 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5407
5408 +++
5409 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5410 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5411 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5412
5413 +++
5414 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5415
5416 ---
5417 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5418 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5419 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5420
5421 ---
5422 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5423 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5424
5425 ** Miscellaneous:
5426
5427 +++
5428 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5429
5430 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5431 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5432 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5433 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5434 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5435 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5436 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5437
5438 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5439
5440 +++
5441 *** Variable `local-write-file-hooks' is marked obsolete.
5442
5443 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5444
5445 ---
5446 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5447 running under X.
5448
5449 ** GC changes:
5450
5451 +++
5452 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5453 as the heap size increases.
5454
5455 +++
5456 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5457 on garbage collection.
5458
5459 +++
5460 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5461
5462 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5463 \f
5464 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5465
5466 +++
5467 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5468 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5469 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5470 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5471 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5472
5473 ---
5474 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5475 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5476 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5477
5478 +++
5479 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5480 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5481 data structures.
5482
5483 ---
5484 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5485 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5486
5487 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5488 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5489 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5490 commands.
5491
5492 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5493 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5494 SQL buffer.
5495
5496 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5497 (function (lambda ()
5498 (master-mode t)
5499 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5500 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5501 (function (lambda ()
5502 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5503
5504 +++
5505 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5506
5507 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5508
5509 +++
5510 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5511
5512 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5513 code. It works with edebug.
5514
5515 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5516 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5517 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5518 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5519 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5520
5521 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5522 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5523 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5524 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5525 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5526 value, such as (setq x 14).
5527
5528 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5529 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5530 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5531 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5532 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5533 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5534 \f
5535 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5536
5537 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5538 been added.
5539
5540 \f
5541 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5542
5543 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5544 with Custom.
5545
5546 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5547 as mule-utf-8.
5548
5549 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5550 in UTF-8 locales).
5551
5552 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5553 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5554 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5555 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5556 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5557 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5558 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5559 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5560 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5561 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5562
5563 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5564 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5565
5566 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5567 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5568 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5569 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5570 contrary to the compound text specification.
5571
5572 \f
5573 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5574
5575 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5576
5577 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5578
5579 \f
5580 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5581
5582 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5583
5584 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5585 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5586 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5587 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5588 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5589
5590 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5591 were changed.
5592
5593 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5594 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5595
5596 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5597 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5598 instead of using default-major-mode.
5599
5600 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5601 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5602 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5603 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5604 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5605 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5606 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5607
5608 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5609 NEWS.
5610
5611 \f
5612 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5613
5614 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5615 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5616 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5617
5618 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5619 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5620
5621 \f
5622 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5623
5624 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5625 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5626 charsets in this release.
5627
5628 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5629
5630 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5631
5632 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5633 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5634 to list them.
5635
5636 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5637 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5638 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5639 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5640 necessary changes to unexec.
5641
5642 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5643 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5644
5645 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5646 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5647
5648 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5649 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5650
5651 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5652 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5653 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5654 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5655 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5656
5657 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5658 new display features described below.
5659
5660 \f
5661 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5662
5663 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5664
5665 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5666 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5667 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5668 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5669 the text.
5670
5671 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5672
5673 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5674 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5675 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5676 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5677 specify a font.
5678
5679 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5680 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5681 under Lisp changes, below.
5682
5683 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5684
5685 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5686 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5687 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5688 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5689 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5690 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5691 on terminals.
5692
5693 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5694 supported on character terminals.
5695
5696 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5697 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5698 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5699 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5700
5701 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5702
5703 ** Sound support
5704
5705 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5706 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5707 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5708 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5709 sound support.
5710
5711 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5712
5713 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5714 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5715 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5716 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5717
5718 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5719
5720 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5721 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5722 specifies a number of lines.
5723
5724 Default is 0.25.
5725
5726 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5727
5728 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5729 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5730 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5731 again.
5732
5733 Default is `grow-only'.
5734
5735 ** LessTif support.
5736
5737 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5738 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5739
5740 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5741
5742 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5743 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5744 non-nil.
5745
5746 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5747
5748 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5749 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5750 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5751
5752 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5753
5754 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5755 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5756 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5757 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5758 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5759 Emacs.
5760
5761 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5762 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5763 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5764 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5765 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5766 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5767
5768 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5769 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5770 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5771 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5772 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5773 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5774
5775 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5776 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5777 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5778 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5779 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5780
5781 ** Tool bar support.
5782
5783 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5784 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5785 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5786 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5787 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5788 icons will be used.
5789
5790 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5791 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5792
5793 ** Tooltips.
5794
5795 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5796 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5797 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5798
5799 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5800 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5801 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5802 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5803
5804 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5805
5806 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5807 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5808 customized.
5809
5810 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5811 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5812 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5813 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5814 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5815
5816 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5817 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5818 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5819 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5820 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5821 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5822
5823 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5824 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5825 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5826 customizing face `fringe'.
5827
5828 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5829 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5830 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5831 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5832 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5833 the window to be partially obscured.)
5834
5835 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5836 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5837 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5838 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5839
5840 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5841
5842 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5843 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5844 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5845 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5846 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5847 have enabled one.
5848
5849 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5850
5851 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5852
5853 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5854
5855 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5856 `*') toggles the status.
5857
5858 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5859
5860 ** Hourglass pointer
5861
5862 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5863 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5864
5865 ** Blinking cursor
5866
5867 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5868 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5869 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5870 the group `cursor'.
5871
5872 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5873
5874 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5875 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5876 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5877 details.
5878
5879 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5880 have to do anything to activate it.
5881
5882 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5883
5884 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5885 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5886
5887 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5888 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5889 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5890 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5891 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5892 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5893 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5894 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5895
5896 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5897 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5898 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5899 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5900 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5901 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5902
5903 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5904 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5905
5906 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5907 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5908 buffer by default.
5909
5910 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5911 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5912 beginning and end of the buffer.
5913
5914 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5915 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5916 signaled.
5917
5918 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5919 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5920
5921 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5922 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5923 this behavior.
5924
5925 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5926 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5927 Emacs dump core.
5928
5929 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5930
5931 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5932 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5933 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5934
5935 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5936 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5937 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5938
5939 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5940 using that menu.
5941
5942 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5943
5944 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5945 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5946 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5947 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5948 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5949 whitespace.
5950
5951 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5952 all frames except the selected one.
5953
5954 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5955 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5956
5957 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5958 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5959 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5960 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5961 `Info-use-header-line'.
5962
5963 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5964 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5965 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5966
5967 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5968
5969 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5970 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5971 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5972
5973 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5974 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5975 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5976 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5977
5978 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5979
5980 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5981 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5982 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5983 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5984
5985 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5986 point in a pop-up window.
5987
5988 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5989 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5990 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5991
5992 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5993 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5994
5995 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5996 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5997 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5998 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5999
6000 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
6001
6002 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6003 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6004
6005 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
6006 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
6007 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
6008
6009 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
6010 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
6011 non-nil.
6012
6013 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
6014 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
6015 file that is already visited under a different name.
6016
6017 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
6018 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
6019
6020 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
6021 and displays information about that.
6022
6023 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
6024 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
6025
6026 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
6027 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
6028 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
6029 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
6030 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
6031 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
6032
6033 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
6034 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
6035
6036 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
6037 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
6038 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
6039 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
6040 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
6041 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
6042 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
6043
6044 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
6045 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
6046
6047 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
6048 system for keyboard input.
6049
6050 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
6051 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
6052 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
6053 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
6054 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
6055 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
6056 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
6057 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
6058 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
6059
6060 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
6061 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
6062
6063 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
6064 displays all characters in that character set.
6065
6066 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
6067 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
6068
6069 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
6070 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
6071 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
6072
6073 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
6074 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
6075 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
6076 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
6077 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
6078 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6079 and Polish `slash'.
6080
6081 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6082 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6083 of the tutorial.
6084
6085 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6086 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6087 Lisp Coding Convention".
6088
6089 new command old-binding
6090 --- ------- -----------
6091 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6092 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6093 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6094
6095 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6096 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6097 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6098
6099 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6100 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6101 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6102 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6103 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6104 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6105
6106 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6107 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6108 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6109 package.
6110
6111 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6112 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6113 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6114 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6115 "`", you must type "=q".
6116
6117 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6118 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6119 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6120 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6121 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6122 on.
6123
6124 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6125 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6126 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6127 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6128
6129 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6130 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6131 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6132 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6133
6134 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6135 on the display using several methods
6136
6137 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6138 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6139 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6140
6141 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6142 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6143
6144 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6145
6146 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6147 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6148
6149 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6150 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6151 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6152 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6153
6154 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6155 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6156 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6157
6158 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6159 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6160
6161 ** New X resources recognized
6162
6163 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6164 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6165 is useful for debugging X problems.
6166
6167 Example:
6168
6169 emacs.synchronous: true
6170
6171 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6172 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6173 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6174 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6175 visual class names are
6176
6177 TrueColor
6178 PseudoColor
6179 DirectColor
6180 StaticColor
6181 GrayScale
6182 StaticGray
6183
6184 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6185 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6186 meaning.
6187
6188 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6189 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6190 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6191 visual.
6192
6193 Example:
6194
6195 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6196
6197 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6198 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6199 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6200 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6201
6202 Example:
6203
6204 emacs.privateColormap: true
6205
6206 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6207
6208 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6209 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6210 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6211 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6212 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6213 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6214 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6215
6216 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6217 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6218 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6219 `default' face and vice versa.
6220
6221 ** New face `menu'.
6222
6223 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6224
6225 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6226
6227 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6228 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6229 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6230 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6231
6232 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6233 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6234 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6235
6236 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6237 `ScreenGamma'.
6238
6239 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6240
6241 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6242 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6243 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6244 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6245
6246 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6247
6248 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6249
6250 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6251
6252 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6253 LessTif/Motif one.
6254
6255 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6256 LessTif and Motif.
6257
6258 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6259
6260 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6261 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6262 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6263
6264 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6265 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6266
6267 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6268 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6269 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6270
6271 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6272
6273 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6274 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6275 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6276 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6277
6278 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6279 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6280 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6281 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6282
6283 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6284 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6285 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6286 buffers.
6287
6288 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6289
6290 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6291 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6292 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6293
6294 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6295 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6296 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6297 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6298 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6299 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6300
6301 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6302
6303 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6304 notably at the end of lines.
6305
6306 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6307 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6308
6309 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6310
6311 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6312 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6313
6314 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6315 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6316 after each match to get the replacement text.
6317
6318 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6319 you edit the replacement string.
6320
6321 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6322 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6323 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6324
6325 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6326
6327 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6328 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6329
6330 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6331 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6332 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6333 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6334
6335 --
6336 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6337 read mail from the menu etc.
6338
6339 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6340 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6341 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6342 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6343
6344 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6345 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6346
6347 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6348 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6349 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6350 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6351 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6352 of Emacs.
6353
6354 ** Customize changes
6355
6356 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6357 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6358 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6359 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6360 earlier versions of Emacs.
6361
6362 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6363 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6364 default).
6365
6366 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6367 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6368 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6369 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6370 file.
6371
6372 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6373 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6374 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6375 already in your init file.
6376
6377 ** New features in evaluation commands
6378
6379 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6380 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6381 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6382 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6383 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6384
6385 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6386 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6387 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6388 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6389 printed).
6390
6391 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6392 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6393
6394 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6395 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6396
6397 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6398 code when called with a prefix argument.
6399
6400 ** CC mode changes.
6401
6402 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6403 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6404 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6405 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6406 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6407 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6408 release.
6409
6410 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6411 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6412 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6413 confusion.
6414
6415 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6416 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6417 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6418 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6419
6420 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6421 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6422
6423 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6424 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6425
6426 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6427 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6428 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6429 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6430
6431 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6432 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6433 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6434 earlier statement. An example:
6435
6436 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6437 if (a[i])
6438 res += a[i]->offset;
6439 else
6440
6441 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6442 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6443 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6444 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6445 the preceding "if".
6446
6447 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6448 by default.
6449
6450 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6451 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6452 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6453 documentation or other natural language text.
6454
6455 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6456 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6457 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6458 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6459 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6460 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6461 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6462
6463 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6464 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6465 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6466 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6467
6468 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6469 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6470 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6471 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6472 Pike mode only.
6473
6474 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6475 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6476 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6477 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6478 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6479 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6480 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6481 is reported afterwards.
6482
6483 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6484 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6485 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6486
6487 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6488 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6489 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6490 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6491 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6492 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6493 groundwork.
6494
6495 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6496 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6497 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6498 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6499 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6500 have to bother.
6501
6502 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6503 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6504 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6505 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6506 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6507 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6508
6509 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6510 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6511 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6512 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6513 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6514 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6515 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6516 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6517
6518 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6519 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6520 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6521 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6522 above.
6523
6524 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6525 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6526 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6527 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6528 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6529 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6530 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6531 function documentation for more info.
6532
6533 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6534 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6535 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6536 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6537 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6538 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6539 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6540 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6541
6542 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6543
6544 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6545 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6546
6547 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6548 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6549 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6550 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6551 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6552 style system.
6553
6554 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6555 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6556 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6557 as far as possible.
6558
6559 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6560 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6561 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6562 chapter about this in the manual.
6563
6564 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6565 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6566 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6567 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6568 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6569
6570 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6571 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6572 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6573
6574 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6575 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6576
6577 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6578 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6579 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6580 inside CC Mode.
6581
6582 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6583 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6584 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6585 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6586 cc-mode/).
6587
6588 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6589 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6590 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6591 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6592 they were before the filling.
6593
6594 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6595 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6596 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6597 literals.
6598
6599 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6600 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6601 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6602 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6603 this function.
6604
6605 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6606 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6607 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6608 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6609 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6610
6611 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6612 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6613 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6614
6615 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6616
6617 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6618 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6619 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6620 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6621
6622 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6623 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6624 the column specified by comment-column.
6625
6626 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6627 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6628 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6629 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6630 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6631 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6632
6633 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6634 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6635 arguments.
6636
6637 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6638
6639 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6640 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6641 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6642 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6643 Provan).
6644
6645 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6646
6647 ** Dired changes
6648
6649 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6650 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6651 is, delete only empty directories.
6652
6653 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6654 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6655 copy directories recursively.
6656
6657 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6658 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6659 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6660
6661 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6662 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6663 directory.
6664
6665 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6666 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6667 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6668 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6669 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6670
6671 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6672 from ls switches.
6673
6674 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6675 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6676 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6677 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6678
6679 ** Gnus changes.
6680
6681 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6682 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6683 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6684
6685 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6686 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6687
6688 If you used procmail like in
6689
6690 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6691 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6692 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6693 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6694
6695 this now has changed to
6696
6697 (setq mail-sources
6698 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6699 :suffix ".in")))
6700
6701 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6702 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6703
6704 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6705 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6706 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6707 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6708
6709 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6710 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6711 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6712
6713 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6714 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6715 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6716 now just a compatibility layer.
6717
6718 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6719 Gnus facilities.
6720
6721 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6722 called to position point.
6723
6724 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6725 summary buffers and NOV files.
6726
6727 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6728 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6729
6730 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6731 subtly different manner.
6732
6733 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6734 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6735 ever-changing layouts.
6736
6737 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6738
6739 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6740
6741 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6742
6743 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6744 macros
6745
6746 Key binding Macro
6747 -------------------------
6748 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6749 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6750 C-c C-c u @uref
6751 C-c C-c q @quotation
6752 C-c C-c m @email
6753 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6754 M-RET @item
6755
6756 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6757
6758 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6759
6760 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6761 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6762 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6763
6764 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6765
6766 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6767 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6768 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6769 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6770 buffers to kill, as before.
6771
6772 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6773 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6774 this way.
6775
6776 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6777 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6778
6779 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6780
6781 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6782 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6783 use. Default is 1000.
6784
6785 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6786 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6787
6788 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6789
6790 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6791
6792 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6793 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6794 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6795 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6796
6797 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6798 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6799 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6800 the open block.
6801
6802 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6803 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6804 the normal block-hiding function.
6805
6806 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6807
6808 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6809 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6810 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6811 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6812
6813 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6814 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6815
6816 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6817
6818 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6819 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6820 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6821
6822 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6823 current buffer.
6824
6825 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6826 in a log file.
6827
6828 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6829 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6830 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6831 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6832 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6833 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6834
6835 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6836
6837 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6838
6839 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6840 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6841
6842 ** Changes in Font Lock
6843
6844 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6845 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6846
6847 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6848 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6849
6850 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6851 the face used for each string/comment.
6852
6853 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6854 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6855
6856 ** Changes to Shell mode
6857
6858 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6859 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6860 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6861 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6862
6863 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6864
6865 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6866 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6867
6868 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6869 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6870 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6871 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6872 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6873 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6874
6875 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6876 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6877 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6878 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6879 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6880 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6881 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6882 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6883
6884 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6885 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6886
6887 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6888 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6889 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6890
6891 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6892 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6893 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6894
6895 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6896 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6897 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6898
6899 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6900 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6901 argument, it appends to the file.
6902
6903 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6904 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6905 compatibility.
6906
6907 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6908 ring (history).
6909
6910 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6911 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6912 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6913
6914 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6915
6916 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6917 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6918 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6919 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6920 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6921 as correspondent.
6922
6923 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6924 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6925 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6926
6927 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6928 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6929 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6930 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6931 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6932
6933 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6934 like `j'.
6935
6936 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6937 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6938 digest message.
6939
6940 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6941 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6942
6943 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6944 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6945 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6946
6947 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6948 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6949
6950 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6951 use the -f option when sending mail.
6952
6953 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6954 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6955 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6956 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6957 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6958 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6959
6960 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6961 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6962 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6963
6964 ** Changes to TeX mode
6965
6966 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6967 `latex-mode'.
6968
6969 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6970
6971 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6972
6973 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6974
6975 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6976
6977 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6978 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6979 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6980 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6981 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6982 can be edited from that buffer.
6983
6984 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6985 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6986 `A' to use all marked entries).
6987
6988 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6989 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6990
6991 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6992 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6993 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6994 been cited.
6995
6996 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6997 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6998 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6999 in column 1 are always made leaves.
7000
7001 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
7002 has the following new features:
7003
7004 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
7005 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
7006 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
7007 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
7008
7009 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
7010 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
7011 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
7012 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
7013 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
7014 defaults to 1.
7015
7016 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
7017 file names.
7018
7019 ** Ispell changes
7020
7021 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
7022 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
7023 spell-checks the current buffer.
7024
7025 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
7026 added.
7027
7028 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
7029 correction is made and re-checked.
7030
7031 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
7032
7033 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
7034 cases.
7035
7036 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
7037 on syntax errors.
7038
7039 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
7040 end of the buffer.
7041
7042 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
7043
7044 ** Makefile mode changes
7045
7046 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
7047
7048 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
7049 Fontlock mode is active.
7050
7051 ** Isearch changes
7052
7053 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
7054 so that searches can be resumed.
7055
7056 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
7057 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
7058 that started the search.
7059
7060 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
7061 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
7062
7063 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
7064
7065 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
7066 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
7067 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
7068 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
7069 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
7070 `secondary-selection'.
7071
7072 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
7073 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
7074 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
7075 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
7076 usual snappy response.
7077
7078 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7079 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7080 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7081 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7082
7083 ** VC Changes
7084
7085 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7086 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7087 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7088 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7089 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7090 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7091 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7092 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7093 file is registered in that backend.
7094
7095 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7096 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7097 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7098 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7099 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7100 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7101
7102 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7103 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7104 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7105 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7106 where it doesn't make sense.)
7107
7108 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7109 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7110 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7111
7112 *** General Changes
7113
7114 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7115 checks are always done now.
7116
7117 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7118 operations.
7119
7120 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7121 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7122 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7123
7124 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7125 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7126 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7127 the working file (``merge news'').
7128
7129 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7130 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7131 downwards.
7132
7133 *** Multiple Backends
7134
7135 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7136 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7137 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7138 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7139 local RCS archives.
7140
7141 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7142 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7143 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7144 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7145
7146 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7147 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7148 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7149 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7150 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7151
7152 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7153 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7154 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7155 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7156
7157 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7158 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7159 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7160 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7161
7162 *** Changes for CVS
7163
7164 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7165 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7166 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7167 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7168 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7169 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7170 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7171
7172 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7173 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7174 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7175 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7176 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7177 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7178 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7179 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7180 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7181 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7182 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7183 name.)
7184
7185 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7186 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7187 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7188 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7189 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7190 entire directory tree.
7191
7192 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7193 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7194 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7195 "watched" by other developers.)
7196
7197 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7198 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7199 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7200 starting at the given directory.
7201
7202 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7203
7204 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7205 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7206 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7207 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7208 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7209 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7210 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7211 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7212 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7213
7214 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7215 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7216 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7217 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7218
7219 ** New modes and packages
7220
7221 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7222 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7223 the default is not applicable.
7224
7225 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7226 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7227 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7228
7229 Features are:
7230
7231 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7232 drawn, like this: | \ /
7233 --+-- X
7234 | / \
7235
7236 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7237 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7238 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7239 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7240 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7241 you are drawing.
7242
7243 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7244 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7245
7246 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7247 flood-filling.
7248
7249 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7250 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7251 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7252 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7253
7254 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7255 also do without the mouse.
7256
7257 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7258 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7259 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7260 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7261 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7262
7263 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7264
7265 lines straight-lines
7266 rectangles squares
7267 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7268 ellipses circles
7269 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7270 spray-can setting size for spraying
7271 vaporize line vaporize lines
7272 erase characters erase rectangles
7273
7274 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7275 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7276 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7277 drawing.
7278
7279 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7280 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7281 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7282 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7283
7284 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7285 can be turned off).
7286
7287 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7288 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7289 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7290 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7291 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7292 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7293 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7294 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7295 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7296
7297 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7298 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7299 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7300 on certain projects.
7301
7302 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7303 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7304
7305 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7306
7307 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7308 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7309 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7310 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7311 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7312 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7313 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7314 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7315
7316 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7317 Emacs is idle.
7318
7319 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7320 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7321
7322 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7323 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7324
7325 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7326 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7327 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7328 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7329 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7330
7331 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7332 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7333 separate Texinfo file.
7334
7335 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7336 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7337 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7338 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7339 enter check-in log messages.
7340
7341 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7342 without invoking external programs.
7343
7344 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7345 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7346 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7347 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7348 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7349
7350 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7351 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7352
7353 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7354 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7355
7356 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7357 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7358 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7359 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7360 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7361 single step.
7362
7363 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7364 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7365 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7366 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7367
7368 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7369 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7370 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7371
7372 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7373 PostScript.
7374
7375 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7376
7377 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7378
7379 ; comment (until end of line)
7380 A non-terminal
7381 "C" terminal
7382 ?C? special
7383 $A default non-terminal
7384 $"C" default terminal
7385 $?C? default special
7386 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7387 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7388 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7389 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7390 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7391 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7392 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7393 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7394 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7395 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7396 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7397 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7398 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7399 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7400 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7401
7402 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7403
7404 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7405 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7406 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7407 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7408 equal signs of assignments.
7409
7410 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7411 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7412
7413 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7414 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7415 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7416
7417 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7418
7419 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7420 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7421 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7422 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7423 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7424 which answers different needs.
7425
7426 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7427 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7428 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7429 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7430 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7431 to be enabled.
7432
7433 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7434 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7435
7436 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7437
7438 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7439 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7440 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7441
7442 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7443
7444 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7445 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7446 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7447 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7448 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7449 and background colors.
7450
7451 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7452 Pascal) language.
7453
7454 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7455 the text at point.
7456
7457 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7458
7459 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7460
7461 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7462 whitespace in a file.
7463
7464 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7465 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7466 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7467 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7468 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7469 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7470 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7471
7472 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7473
7474 Here is an example of columns:
7475
7476 horse apple bus
7477 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7478 porcupine strawberry airplane
7479
7480 Doing the following settings:
7481
7482 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7483 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7484 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7485 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7486
7487
7488 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7489
7490 M-x delimit-columns-region
7491
7492 It results:
7493
7494 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7495 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7496 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7497
7498 delim-col has the following options:
7499
7500 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7501 before all columns.
7502
7503 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7504 between each column.
7505
7506 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7507 after all columns.
7508
7509 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7510 each column.
7511
7512 delim-col has the following commands:
7513
7514 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7515 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7516
7517 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7518 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7519 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7520 recent file list can be displayed:
7521
7522 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7523 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7524 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7525
7526 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7527 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7528
7529 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7530 text.
7531
7532 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7533 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7534 specific to Message mode.
7535
7536 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7537 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7538 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7539
7540 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7541 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7542 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7543
7544 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7545 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7546
7547 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7548
7549 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7550 minibuffer with completion.
7551
7552 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7553 with the diary features.
7554
7555 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7556 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7557
7558 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7559 Fill mode.
7560
7561 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7562 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7563 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7564 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7565
7566 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7567 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7568 `.g'.
7569
7570 ** Changes in sort.el
7571
7572 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7573 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7574 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7575 numeric base.
7576
7577 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7578
7579 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7580 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7581 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7582
7583 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7584 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7585
7586 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7587 output ^M at the end of lines.
7588
7589 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7590 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7591
7592 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7593 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7594 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7595
7596 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7597 group.
7598
7599 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7600 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7601 are recognized:
7602
7603 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7604 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7605 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7606 nil -- just delete one character.
7607
7608 Default value is `untabify'.
7609
7610 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7611
7612 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7613 symbol, not double-quoted.
7614
7615 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7616 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7617 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7618 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7619
7620 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7621 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7622 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7623
7624 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7625 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7626 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7627
7628 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7629 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7630
7631 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7632 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7633
7634 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7635 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7636
7637 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7638 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7639 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7640 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7641 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7642 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7643
7644 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7645 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7646
7647 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7648
7649 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7650 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7651
7652 ** Shell script mode changes.
7653
7654 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7655 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7656 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7657
7658 ** Etags changes.
7659
7660 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7661
7662 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7663 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7664 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7665 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7666 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7667
7668 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7669 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7670
7671 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7672 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7673
7674 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7675 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7676 `template' keywords.
7677
7678 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7679 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7680
7681 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7682 types.
7683
7684 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7685
7686 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7687
7688 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7689 are now tagged.
7690
7691 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7692
7693 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7694 variables are tagged.
7695
7696 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7697
7698 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7699 for PSWrap.
7700
7701 ** Changes in etags.el
7702
7703 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7704 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7705 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7706
7707 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7708 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7709
7710 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7711 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7712 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7713 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7714
7715 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7716
7717 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7718 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7719
7720 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7721
7722 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7723 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7724 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7725
7726 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7727 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7728
7729 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7730 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7731
7732 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7733 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7734 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7735 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7736 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7737
7738 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7739 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7740 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7741
7742 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7743 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7744 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7745
7746 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7747 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7748 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7749
7750 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7751
7752 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7753
7754 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7755 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7756 expression from that list, are not checked.
7757
7758 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7759 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7760 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7761 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7762
7763 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7764
7765 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7766 displays local abbrevs, only.
7767
7768 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7769 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7770
7771 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7772 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7773 is measured in pixels.
7774
7775 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7776 to be visited as images.
7777
7778 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7779 were added to compile.el.
7780
7781 ** Withdrawn packages
7782
7783 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7784 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7785
7786 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7787
7788 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7789
7790 \f
7791 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7792
7793 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7794 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7795 See the sections below for details.
7796
7797 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7798 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7799 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7800 to remove the properties of the copy.
7801
7802 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7803 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7804 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7805 these properties are active.
7806
7807 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7808 ranges may affect some code.
7809
7810 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7811 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7812 make a difference to some code.
7813
7814 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7815 operates on the minibuffer.
7816
7817 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7818 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7819 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7820 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7821 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7822 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7823 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7824 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7825 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7826 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7827 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7828 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7829
7830 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7831 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7832 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7833
7834 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7835 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7836 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7837
7838 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7839 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7840 such as `mapconcat'.
7841
7842 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7843 string.
7844
7845 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7846 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7847 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7848 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7849 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7850 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7851 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7852 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7853
7854 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7855 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7856 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7857 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7858 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7859 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7860 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7861 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7862 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7863 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7864
7865 \f
7866 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7867 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7868
7869 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7870
7871 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7872 allows the animated display of strings.
7873
7874 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7875 interactive form of a function.
7876
7877 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7878 between custom options. Example:
7879
7880 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7881 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7882 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7883 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7884 :group 'mule
7885 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7886 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7887
7888 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7889 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7890 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7891
7892 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7893 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7894 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7895 (signal or normal termination).
7896
7897 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7898 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7899
7900 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7901 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7902
7903 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7904 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7905
7906 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7907
7908 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7909 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7910 being deleted.
7911
7912 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7913
7914 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7915 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7916 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7917 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7918 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7919 charset.
7920
7921 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7922 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7923 message.
7924
7925 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7926 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7927
7928 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7929 with the more general `:mask' property.
7930
7931 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7932
7933 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7934 backslash.
7935
7936 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7937 is running in batch mode. For example,
7938
7939 (message "%s" (read t))
7940
7941 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7942 to standard output.
7943
7944 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7945 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7946
7947 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7948 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7949 frame or window.
7950
7951 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7952 were added
7953
7954 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7955
7956 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7957 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7958
7959 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7960
7961 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7962 comparison is done with `eq'.
7963
7964 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7965
7966 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7967 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7968 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7969
7970 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7971 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7972 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7973
7974 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7975 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7976
7977 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7978 function was declared obsolete.
7979
7980 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7981 retained as an alias).
7982
7983 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7984 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7985
7986 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7987
7988 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7989
7990 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7991 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7992 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7993 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7994 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7995 means never include the minibuffer window.
7996
7997 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7998
7999 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
8000
8001 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
8002
8003 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
8004 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
8005 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
8006 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
8007 returned.
8008
8009 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
8010 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
8011 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
8012 minibuffer even if it is active.
8013
8014 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
8015 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
8016 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
8017 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
8018 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
8019 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
8020
8021 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
8022 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
8023 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
8024 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
8025 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
8026 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
8027 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
8028
8029 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
8030 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
8031 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
8032
8033 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
8034 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
8035 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
8036 Default value is nil.
8037
8038 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
8039 meaning no limit.
8040
8041 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
8042 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
8043 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
8044
8045 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
8046 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
8047 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
8048
8049 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
8050 list of a primitive.
8051
8052 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
8053
8054 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
8055 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
8056 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
8057 than replacing the local map.
8058
8059 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
8060 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
8061 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
8062 instead.
8063
8064 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
8065
8066 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
8067 as promised long ago.
8068
8069 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
8070
8071 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
8072 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
8073 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
8074
8075 \f
8076 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
8077
8078 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8079 regular expressions.
8080
8081 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8082
8083 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8084
8085 - Macro: rx SEXP
8086
8087 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8088
8089 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8090 notation.
8091
8092 STRING
8093 matches string STRING literally.
8094
8095 CHAR
8096 matches character CHAR literally.
8097
8098 `not-newline'
8099 matches any character except a newline.
8100 .
8101 `anything'
8102 matches any character
8103
8104 `(any SET)'
8105 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8106 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8107
8108 '(in SET)'
8109 like `any'.
8110
8111 `(not (any SET))'
8112 matches any character not in SET
8113
8114 `line-start'
8115 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8116 in the text being matched
8117
8118 `line-end'
8119 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8120
8121 `string-start'
8122 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8123 string being matched against.
8124
8125 `string-end'
8126 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8127 string being matched against.
8128
8129 `buffer-start'
8130 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8131 buffer being matched against.
8132
8133 `buffer-end'
8134 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8135 buffer being matched against.
8136
8137 `point'
8138 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8139
8140 `word-start'
8141 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8142 word.
8143
8144 `word-end'
8145 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8146
8147 `word-boundary'
8148 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8149 word.
8150
8151 `(not word-boundary)'
8152 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8153 word.
8154
8155 `digit'
8156 matches 0 through 9.
8157
8158 `control'
8159 matches ASCII control characters.
8160
8161 `hex-digit'
8162 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8163
8164 `blank'
8165 matches space and tab only.
8166
8167 `graphic'
8168 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8169 space, and DEL.
8170
8171 `printing'
8172 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8173 and DEL.
8174
8175 `alphanumeric'
8176 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8177 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8178
8179 `letter'
8180 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8181 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8182
8183 `ascii'
8184 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8185
8186 `nonascii'
8187 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8188
8189 `lower'
8190 matches anything lower-case.
8191
8192 `upper'
8193 matches anything upper-case.
8194
8195 `punctuation'
8196 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8197 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8198
8199 `space'
8200 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8201
8202 `word'
8203 matches anything that has word syntax.
8204
8205 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8206 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8207 of the following symbols.
8208
8209 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8210 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8211 `word' (\\sw)
8212 `symbol' (\\s_)
8213 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8214 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8215 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8216 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8217 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8218 `escape' (\\s\\)
8219 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8220 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8221 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8222
8223 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8224 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8225
8226 `(category CATEGORY)'
8227 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8228 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8229
8230 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8231 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8232 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8233 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8234 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8235 `symbol' (\\c5)
8236 `digit' (\\c6)
8237 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8238 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8239 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8240 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8241 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8242 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8243 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8244 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8245 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8246 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8247 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8248 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8249 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8250 `ascii' (\\ca)
8251 `arabic' (\\cb)
8252 `chinese' (\\cc)
8253 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8254 `greek' (\\cg)
8255 `korean' (\\ch)
8256 `indian' (\\ci)
8257 `japanese' (\\cj)
8258 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8259 `latin' (\\cl)
8260 `lao' (\\co)
8261 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8262 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8263 `thai' (\\ct)
8264 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8265 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8266 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8267 `can-break' (\\c|)
8268
8269 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8270 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8271
8272 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8273 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8274
8275 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8276 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8277 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8278
8279 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8280 another name for `submatch'.
8281
8282 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8283 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8284 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8285 regular expression.
8286
8287 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8288 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8289 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8290 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8291 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8292
8293 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8294 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8295
8296 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8297 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8298
8299 `(0+ SEXP)'
8300 like `zero-or-more'.
8301
8302 `(* SEXP)'
8303 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8304
8305 `(*? SEXP)'
8306 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8307
8308 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8309 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8310
8311 `(1+ SEXP)'
8312 like `one-or-more'.
8313
8314 `(+ SEXP)'
8315 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8316
8317 `(+? SEXP)'
8318 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8319
8320 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8321 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8322
8323 `(optional SEXP)'
8324 like `zero-or-one'.
8325
8326 `(? SEXP)'
8327 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8328
8329 `(?? SEXP)'
8330 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8331
8332 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8333 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8334
8335 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8336 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8337
8338 `(eval FORM)'
8339 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8340 `regexp-quote' it.
8341
8342 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8343 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8344
8345 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8346
8347 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8348 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8349 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8350 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8351
8352 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8353 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8354 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8355 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8356
8357 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8358 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8359 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8360
8361 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8362 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8363 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8364 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8365 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8366 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8367 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8368 eight-bit-graphic.
8369
8370 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8371
8372 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8373 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8374 character set as previously.
8375
8376 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8377 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8378 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8379
8380 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8381 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8382 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8383 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8384
8385 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8386 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8387
8388 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8389 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8390 "fontset-default".
8391
8392 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8393 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8394
8395 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8396 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8397 buffers and strings.
8398
8399 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8400 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8401 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8402 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8403 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8404 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8405 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8406 also been deleted.
8407
8408 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8409 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8410 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8411
8412 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8413 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8414 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8415 may differ between buffer and string text.
8416
8417 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8418 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8419
8420 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8421 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8422 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8423 `composition' from STRING.
8424
8425 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8426 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8427
8428 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8429 obsolete.
8430
8431 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8432 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8433
8434 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8435 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8436 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8437 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8438
8439 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8440 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8441 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8442 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8443 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8444 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8445
8446 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8447 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8448 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8449
8450 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8451 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8452 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8453
8454 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8455 have been introduced.
8456
8457 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8458 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8459 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8460 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8461 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8462 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8463 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8464 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8465 their multibyte equivalent.
8466
8467 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8468 that offset in the file before writing.
8469
8470 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8471 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8472
8473 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8474 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8475 from which the command was issued.
8476
8477 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8478 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8479 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8480 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8481 operate on.
8482
8483 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8484 to `window-buffer-height'.
8485
8486 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8487
8488 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8489 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8490 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8491
8492 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8493 respectively.
8494
8495 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8496 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8497
8498 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8499 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8500 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8501
8502 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8503 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8504 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8505 is currently displayed in some window.
8506
8507 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8508 argument function's results.
8509
8510 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8511 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8512 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8513 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8514 sequence).
8515
8516 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8517 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8518
8519 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8520 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8521
8522 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8523 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8524 as follows:
8525
8526 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8527 nil don't display a cursor
8528 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8529 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8530 others display a box cursor.
8531
8532 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8533 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8534 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8535 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8536
8537 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8538 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8539 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8540 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8541
8542 Example:
8543
8544 (string-to-syntax "()")
8545 => (4 . 41)
8546
8547 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8548 other than 10.
8549
8550 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8551 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8552
8553 #b1111
8554 => 15
8555 #b-1111
8556 => -15
8557
8558 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8559
8560 #o666
8561 => 438
8562
8563 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8564
8565 #xbeef
8566 => 48815
8567
8568 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8569
8570 #2R-111
8571 => -7
8572 #25rah
8573 => 267
8574
8575 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8576 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8577 and isn't a string.
8578
8579 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8580 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8581 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8582 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8583
8584 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8585
8586 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8587 for a regexp in a string.
8588
8589 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8590 `mouse-position-function'.
8591
8592 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8593 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8594
8595 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8596 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8597
8598 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8599 returns it.
8600
8601 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8602 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8603
8604 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8605 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8606 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8607 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8608 mode.
8609
8610 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8611 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8612
8613 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8614 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8615 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8616 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8617 been performed."
8618
8619 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8620 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8621 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8622 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8623
8624 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8625 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8626 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8627
8628 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8629 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8630 specified table.
8631
8632 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8633
8634 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8635 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8636 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8637 what BODY returns.
8638
8639 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8640 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8641 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8642 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8643 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8644
8645 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8646 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8647
8648 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8649 instead of being optional.
8650
8651 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8652 modify read-only text.
8653
8654 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8655
8656 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8657 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8658 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8659 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8660 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8661
8662 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8663 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8664 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8665 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8666 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8667 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8668 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8669
8670 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8671 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8672 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8673 start sequences.
8674
8675 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8676 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8677
8678 ** New function `propertize'
8679
8680 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8681 strings with text properties.
8682
8683 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8684
8685 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8686 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8687 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8688 specified value of that property. Example:
8689
8690 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8691
8692 ** push and pop macros.
8693
8694 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8695 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8696 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8697
8698 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8699 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8700 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8701
8702 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8703
8704 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8705 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8706
8707 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8708 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8709 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8710 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8711
8712 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8713 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8714 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8715 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8716
8717 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8718 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8719 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8720 or a sign.
8721
8722 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8723 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8724 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8725 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8726 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8727 space, and DEL.
8728 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8729 and DEL.
8730 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8731 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8732 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8733 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8734 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8735 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8736 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8737 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8738 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8739 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8740 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8741 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8742 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8743 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8744 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8745
8746 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8747
8748 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8749
8750 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8751
8752 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8753 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8754
8755 :test TEST
8756
8757 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8758 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8759 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8760
8761 :size SIZE
8762
8763 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8764 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8765
8766 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8767
8768 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8769 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8770 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8771 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8772 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8773
8774 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8775
8776 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8777 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8778 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8779
8780 :weakness WEAK
8781
8782 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8783 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8784 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8785 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8786 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8787
8788 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8789
8790 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8791
8792 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8793
8794 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8795
8796 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8797
8798 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8799 values are shared.
8800
8801 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8802
8803 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8804
8805 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8806
8807 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8808
8809 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8810
8811 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8812
8813 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8814
8815 Returns the size of TABLE.
8816
8817 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8818
8819 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8820
8821 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8822
8823 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8824
8825 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8826
8827 Clear TABLE.
8828
8829 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8830
8831 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8832 not found.
8833
8834 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8835
8836 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8837 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8838
8839 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8840
8841 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8842
8843 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8844
8845 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8846 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8847
8848 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8849
8850 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8851
8852 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8853
8854 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8855 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8856 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8857 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8858 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8859
8860 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8861
8862 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8863 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8864 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8865
8866 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8867 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8868
8869 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8870 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8871
8872 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8873 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8874
8875 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8876 'case-fold-string-hash))
8877
8878 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8879
8880 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8881
8882 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8883 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8884 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8885
8886 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8887
8888 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8889 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8890
8891 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8892 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8893 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8894 is too short to reach that column.
8895
8896 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8897 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8898 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8899 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8900
8901 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8902 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8903 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8904
8905 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8906 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8907
8908 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8909 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8910
8911 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8912 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8913 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8914 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8915 temporary-file-directory instead.
8916
8917 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8918 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8919 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8920 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8921
8922 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8923 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8924
8925 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8926
8927 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8928 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8929 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8930
8931 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8932
8933 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8934 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8935 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8936 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8937 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8938 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8939
8940 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8941 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8942 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8943 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8944
8945 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8946
8947 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8948 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8949 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8950 result string.
8951
8952 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8953 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8954
8955 Example:
8956
8957 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8958 (s2 "world"))
8959 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8960 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8961 (format s1 s2))
8962
8963 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8964
8965 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8966
8967 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8968 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8969 argument in it.
8970
8971 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8972 (arg "world"))
8973 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8974 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8975 (message msg arg))
8976
8977 ** Sound support
8978
8979 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8980 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8981
8982 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8983 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8984 to enable sound support.
8985
8986 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8987 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8988 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8989 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8990 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8991
8992 The following sound properties are supported:
8993
8994 - `:file FILE'
8995
8996 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8997 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8998
8999 - `:data DATA'
9000
9001 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
9002 may be present, but not both.
9003
9004 - `:volume VOLUME'
9005
9006 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
9007 0..1. This property is optional.
9008
9009 - `:device DEVICE'
9010
9011 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
9012 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
9013
9014 Other properties are ignored.
9015
9016 An alternative interface is called as
9017 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
9018
9019 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
9020
9021 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
9022 a keyword symbol.
9023
9024 ** Changes to garbage collection
9025
9026 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
9027 of live and free strings.
9028
9029 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
9030 strings that have been consed so far.
9031
9032 \f
9033 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
9034 Lisp Manual
9035
9036 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
9037 mini-windows.
9038
9039 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
9040 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
9041 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
9042
9043 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
9044
9045 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
9046
9047 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
9048 image.
9049
9050 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
9051
9052 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
9053
9054 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
9055 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
9056 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
9057 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
9058 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
9059
9060 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
9061 has a mask bitmap.
9062
9063 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
9064
9065 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
9066 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
9067 or omitted means use the selected frame.
9068
9069 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
9070 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
9071
9072 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
9073 optional.
9074
9075 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
9076 below).
9077
9078 \f
9079 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9080
9081 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9082 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9083
9084 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9085 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9086 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9087 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9088 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9089 just display it black instead.
9090
9091 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9092 a line like
9093
9094 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9095
9096 in your `.emacs'.
9097
9098 ** New face implementation.
9099
9100 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9101 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9102
9103 *** New faces.
9104
9105 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9106
9107 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9108
9109 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9110 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9111
9112 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9113
9114 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9115
9116 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9117
9118 6. Foreground color.
9119
9120 7. Background color.
9121
9122 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9123
9124 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9125
9126 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9127
9128 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9129
9130 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9131 color.
9132
9133 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9134 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9135
9136 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9137 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9138 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9139 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9140 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9141 attributes mentioned above.
9142
9143 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9144 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9145 created frames.
9146
9147 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9148 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9149 `fully-specified'.
9150
9151 *** Face merging.
9152
9153 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9154 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9155 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9156 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9157 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9158 results in a fully-specified face.
9159
9160 *** Face realization.
9161
9162 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9163 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9164 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9165 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9166 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9167 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9168
9169 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9170 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9171 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9172 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9173
9174 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9175 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9176 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9177 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9178 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9179
9180 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9181 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9182 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9183 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9184 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9185 Emacs.
9186
9187 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9188 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9189 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9190 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9191
9192 **** Clearing face caches.
9193
9194 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9195 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9196 unused fonts.
9197
9198 *** Font selection.
9199
9200 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9201 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9202 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9203
9204 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9205 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9206 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9207 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9208 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9209
9210 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9211 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9212 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9213
9214 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9215
9216 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9217 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9218 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9219 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9220 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9221 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9222 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9223
9224 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9225 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9226 doesn't exist.
9227
9228 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9229 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9230 registry.
9231
9232 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9233 slightly different.
9234
9235 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9236
9237
9238 **** Scalable fonts
9239
9240 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9241 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9242 servers.
9243
9244 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9245 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9246 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9247 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9248 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9249 that list. Example:
9250
9251 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9252
9253 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9254
9255 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9256
9257 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9258
9259 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9260 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9261 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9262
9263 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9264 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9265 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9266 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9267 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9268 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9269 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9270 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9271 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9272 of the face font sort order.
9273
9274 - Function: x-font-family-list
9275
9276 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9277 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9278 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9279 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9280
9281 - Variable: font-list-limit
9282
9283 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9284 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9285 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9286
9287 *** Setting face attributes.
9288
9289 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9290 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9291 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9292 `face-attribute'.
9293
9294 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9295 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9296
9297 The following attributes are recognized:
9298
9299 `:family'
9300
9301 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9302 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9303 and `?' are allowed.
9304
9305 `:width'
9306
9307 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9308 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9309 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9310 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9311
9312 `:height'
9313
9314 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9315 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9316 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9317 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9318
9319 `:weight'
9320
9321 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9322 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9323 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9324
9325 `:slant'
9326
9327 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9328 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9329 `reverse-oblique'.
9330
9331 `:foreground', `:background'
9332
9333 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9334
9335 `:underline'
9336
9337 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9338 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9339 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9340 don't underline.
9341
9342 `:overline'
9343
9344 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9345 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9346 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9347 overline.
9348
9349 `:strike-through'
9350
9351 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9352 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9353 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9354 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9355
9356 `:box'
9357
9358 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9359 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9360 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9361 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9362 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9363 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9364 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9365 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9366 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9367 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9368 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9369 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9370 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9371 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9372 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9373 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9374 box.
9375
9376 `:inverse-video'
9377
9378 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9379 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9380
9381 `:stipple'
9382
9383 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9384 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9385 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9386 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9387 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9388 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9389
9390 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9391 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9392
9393 `:font'
9394
9395 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9396 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9397 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9398 versions of Emacs.
9399
9400 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9401 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9402 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9403
9404 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9405 `defface'.
9406
9407 `:inherit'
9408
9409 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9410 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9411 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9412
9413 *** Face attributes and X resources
9414
9415 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9416 from X resources:
9417
9418 Face attribute X resource class
9419 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9420 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9421 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9422 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9423 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9424 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9425 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9426 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9427 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9428 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9429 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9430 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9431 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9432 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9433 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9434 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9435 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9436 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9437 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9438 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9439
9440 *** Text property `face'.
9441
9442 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9443 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9444 specification can be
9445
9446 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9447
9448 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9449 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9450 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9451 for face attribute names.
9452
9453 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9454 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9455 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9456
9457 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9458
9459 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9460 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9461 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9462 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9463 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9464 used to clear the mapping table.
9465
9466 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9467
9468 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9469 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9470 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9471 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9472 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9473 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9474 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9475 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9476 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9477 modify their color-related behavior.
9478
9479 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9480 any frame type.
9481
9482 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9483
9484 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9485 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9486 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9487 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9488 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9489 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9490 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9491 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9492 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9493
9494 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9495 display can display image files.
9496
9497 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9498
9499 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9500 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9501 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9502 `Inviolable' option.
9503
9504 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9505 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9506 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9507
9508 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9509
9510 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9511 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9512 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9513
9514 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9515 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9516 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9517 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9518 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9519 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9520 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9521 functions.
9522
9523 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9524 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9525 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9526
9527 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9528
9529 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9530
9531 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9532
9533 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9534 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9535 constrained position if that is different.
9536
9537 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9538 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9539 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9540 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9541 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9542 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9543 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9544 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9545 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9546
9547 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9548 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9549 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9550 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9551 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9552
9553 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9554 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9555
9556 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9557
9558 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9559
9560 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9561 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9562 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9563
9564 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9565
9566 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9567 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9568 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9569 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9570 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9571
9572 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9573
9574 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9575 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9576 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9577 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9578 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9579
9580 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9581
9582 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9583 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9584 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9585
9586 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9587
9588 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9589 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9590 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9591
9592 ** Image support.
9593
9594 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9595 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9596 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9597 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9598
9599 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9600 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9601 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9602 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9603 area.
9604
9605 IMAGE is an image specification.
9606
9607 *** Image specifications
9608
9609 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9610 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9611 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9612 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9613 described below are ignored.
9614
9615 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9616
9617 `:ascent ASCENT'
9618
9619 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9620 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9621 to use for its ascent.
9622
9623 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9624 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9625
9626 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9627 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9628 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9629 overlays that apply to the image.
9630
9631 `:margin MARGIN'
9632
9633 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9634 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9635 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9636
9637 `:relief RELIEF'
9638
9639 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9640 around an image.
9641
9642 `:conversion ALGO'
9643
9644 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9645
9646 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9647 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9648
9649 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9650 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9651 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9652 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9653 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9654 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9655 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9656 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9657 below.
9658
9659 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9660 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9661 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9662
9663 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9664 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9665 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9666 of the factors' absolute values.
9667
9668 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9669
9670 (1 0 0
9671 0 0 0
9672 9 9 -1)
9673
9674 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9675
9676 ( 2 -1 0
9677 -1 0 1
9678 0 1 -2)
9679
9680 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9681 ``disabled''.
9682
9683 `:mask MASK'
9684
9685 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9686 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9687 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9688 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9689 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9690 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9691 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9692 image.
9693
9694 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9695 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9696 `:mask nil'.
9697
9698 `:file FILE'
9699
9700 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9701 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9702 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9703 may be present in the image specification.
9704
9705 `:data DATA'
9706
9707 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9708 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9709 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9710 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9711
9712 *** Supported image types
9713
9714 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9715
9716 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9717 properties supported are:
9718
9719 `:foreground FG'
9720
9721 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9722 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9723
9724 `:background BG'
9725
9726 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9727 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9728
9729 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9730 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9731 instead of a `:file' property.
9732
9733 `:width WIDTH'
9734
9735 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9736
9737 `:height HEIGHT'
9738
9739 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9740
9741 `:data DATA'
9742
9743 DATA must be either
9744
9745 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9746 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9747
9748 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9749
9750 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9751 bitmap.
9752
9753 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9754 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9755 in the file.
9756
9757 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9758
9759 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9760 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9761 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9762 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9763
9764 Additional image properties supported are:
9765
9766 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9767
9768 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9769 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9770 name.
9771
9772 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9773 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9774
9775 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9776 to display compressed images.
9777
9778 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9779
9780 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9781 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9782 mono images are:
9783
9784 `:foreground FG'
9785
9786 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9787 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9788
9789 `:background FG'
9790
9791 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9792 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9793
9794 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9795
9796 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9797 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9798 properties defined.
9799
9800 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9801
9802 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9803 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9804 properties defined.
9805
9806 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9807
9808 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9809 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9810
9811 Additional image properties supported are:
9812
9813 `:index INDEX'
9814
9815 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9816 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9817 as a hollow box.
9818
9819 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9820 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9821 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9822 every 0.1 seconds.
9823
9824 (defun show-anim (file max)
9825 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9826 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9827
9828 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9829 (when (= idx max)
9830 (setq idx 0))
9831 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9832 (save-excursion
9833 (set-buffer buffer)
9834 (goto-char (point-min))
9835 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9836 (insert-image img "x"))
9837 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9838
9839 **** PNG, image type `png'
9840
9841 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9842 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9843 properties defined.
9844
9845 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9846
9847 Additional image properties supported are:
9848
9849 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9850
9851 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9852 integer. This is a required property.
9853
9854 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9855
9856 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9857 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9858
9859 `:bounding-box BOX'
9860
9861 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9862 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9863 files. This is an required property.
9864
9865 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9866 lisp/gs.el.
9867
9868 *** Lisp interface.
9869
9870 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9871 which are supported in the current configuration.
9872
9873 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9874 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9875 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9876 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9877 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9878
9879 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9880
9881 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9882 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9883 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9884 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9885 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9886 buffer.
9887
9888 ** Display margins.
9889
9890 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9891 and images.
9892
9893 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9894 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9895 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9896 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9897 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9898 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9899 of the display margins.
9900
9901 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9902 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9903 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9904 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9905 in this file).
9906
9907 ** Help display
9908
9909 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9910 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9911 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9912 that have a `help-echo' property.
9913
9914 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9915 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9916 the window in which the help was found.
9917
9918 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9919 `help-echo' text property was found.
9920
9921 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9922 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9923
9924 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9925 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9926 mouse.
9927
9928 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9929 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9930
9931 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9932 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9933 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9934 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9935 used as help string.
9936
9937 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9938 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9939 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9940
9941 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9942
9943 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9944 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9945
9946 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9947 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9948 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9949 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9950 used.
9951
9952 (global-set-key [A-down]
9953 #'(lambda ()
9954 (interactive)
9955 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9956 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9957 (global-set-key [A-up]
9958 #'(lambda ()
9959 (interactive)
9960 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9961 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9962
9963 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9964
9965 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9966 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9967 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9968 is called with one argument, POS.
9969
9970 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9971 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9972 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9973 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9974 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9975
9976 ** Tool bar support.
9977
9978 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9979 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9980 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9981 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9982 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9983 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9984
9985 *** Tool bar item definitions
9986
9987 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9988 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9989 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9990
9991 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9992 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9993 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9994 property (see below).
9995
9996 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9997 binding are currently ignored.
9998
9999 The following properties are recognized:
10000
10001 `:enable FORM'.
10002
10003 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
10004 or disabled.
10005
10006 `:visible FORM'
10007
10008 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
10009
10010 `:filter FUNCTION'
10011
10012 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
10013 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
10014 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
10015
10016 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
10017
10018 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
10019 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
10020
10021 `:image IMAGES'
10022
10023 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
10024 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
10025 meaning of each of the four elements:
10026
10027 Index Use when item is
10028 ----------------------------------------
10029 0 enabled and selected
10030 1 enabled and deselected
10031 2 disabled and selected
10032 3 disabled and deselected
10033
10034 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
10035 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
10036
10037 `:help HELP-STRING'.
10038
10039 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
10040 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
10041
10042 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
10043 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
10044 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
10045 menu bar.
10046
10047 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
10048 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
10049 buffer-locally to override the global map.
10050
10051 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
10052
10053 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
10054 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
10055 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
10056
10057 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
10058 raised when the mouse moves over them.
10059
10060 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
10061 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
10062 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
10063 vertical margins . Default is 1.
10064
10065 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
10066 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
10067
10068 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
10069
10070 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
10071 a tool bar item. If
10072
10073 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
10074 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
10075 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
10076
10077 is the original tool bar item definition, then
10078
10079 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10080
10081 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10082 item.
10083
10084 ** Mode line changes.
10085
10086 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10087
10088 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10089 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10090 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10091
10092 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10093 a `local-map' text property.
10094
10095 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10096 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10097
10098 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10099 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10100 `local-map' property.
10101
10102 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10103 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10104 example.
10105
10106 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10107 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10108
10109 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10110 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10111
10112 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10113
10114 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10115 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10116 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10117 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10118 line.
10119
10120 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10121 `header-line'.
10122
10123 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10124 position in the header-line.
10125
10126 ** Text property `display'
10127
10128 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10129 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10130 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10131 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10132 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10133
10134 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10135
10136 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10137 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10138
10139 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10140 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10141 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10142 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10143 simpler form STRING as property value.
10144
10145 *** Variable width and height spaces
10146
10147 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10148 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10149 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10150 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10151 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10152 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10153 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10154
10155 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10156 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10157 properties described below.
10158
10159 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10160 characters having the `display' property.
10161
10162 - :width WIDTH
10163
10164 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10165 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10166
10167 - :relative-width FACTOR
10168
10169 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10170 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10171 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10172 width of that character by FACTOR.
10173
10174 - :align-to HPOS
10175
10176 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10177 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10178
10179 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10180
10181 - :height HEIGHT
10182
10183 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10184 normal line height.
10185
10186 - :relative-height FACTOR
10187
10188 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10189 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10190
10191 - :ascent ASCENT
10192
10193 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10194 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10195 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10196 equal to 100.
10197
10198 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10199
10200 *** Images
10201
10202 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10203 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10204 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10205 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10206 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10207 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10208 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10209 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10210 as display specification.
10211
10212 *** Other display properties
10213
10214 - (space-width FACTOR)
10215
10216 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10217 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10218 integer or float.
10219
10220 - (height HEIGHT)
10221
10222 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10223
10224 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10225 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10226 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10227 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10228 a font is available counts as a step.
10229
10230 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10231 as tall as the frame's default font.
10232
10233 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10234 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10235
10236 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10237 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10238
10239 - (raise FACTOR)
10240
10241 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10242 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10243 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10244 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10245 `height' subproperty.
10246
10247 *** Conditional display properties
10248
10249 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10250 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10251 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10252 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10253 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10254 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10255 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10256 different when object is a string.
10257
10258 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10259 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10260
10261 ** New menu separator types.
10262
10263 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10264 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10265 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10266 to specify other menu separator types.
10267
10268 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10269
10270 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10271 separator occurs.
10272
10273 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10274
10275 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10276
10277 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10278
10279 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10280
10281 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10282
10283 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10284
10285 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10286
10287 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10288
10289 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10290
10291 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10292 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10293
10294 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10295
10296 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10297
10298 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10299
10300 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10301
10302 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10303
10304 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10305
10306 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10307
10308 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10309
10310 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10311
10312 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10313
10314 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10315
10316 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10317
10318 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10319
10320 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10321
10322 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10323 the corresponding single-line separators.
10324
10325 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10326
10327 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10328 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10329 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10330 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10331 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10332 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10333 default foreground is black.
10334
10335 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10336 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10337 `ScrollBarBackground').
10338
10339 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10340 settings for scroll bar colors.
10341
10342 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10343 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10344
10345 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10346 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10347 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10348 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10349 the original window start.
10350
10351 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10352 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10353 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10354
10355 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10356
10357 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10358 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10359 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10360 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10361
10362 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10363 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10364
10365 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10366
10367 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10368 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10369 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10370 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10371 temporarily to nil, for example
10372
10373 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10374 (enlarge-window 10))
10375
10376 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10377 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10378
10379 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10380 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10381 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10382 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10383 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10384 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10385
10386
10387 \f
10388 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10389
10390 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10391 input.
10392
10393 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10394
10395 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10396
10397 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10398 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10399 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10400 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10401 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10402
10403 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10404 been added.
10405
10406 \f
10407 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10408
10409 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10410
10411
10412 \f
10413 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10414
10415 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10416 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10417 \f
10418 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10419
10420 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10421
10422 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10423 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10424 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10425
10426 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10427 is the one that is used.
10428
10429 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10430 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10431 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10432 separate from the command's regular output.
10433 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10434 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10435 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10436 the buffer name.
10437
10438 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10439 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10440 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10441 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10442
10443 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10444 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10445 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10446 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10447
10448 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10449 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10450 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10451 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10452
10453 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10454 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10455 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10456 they never ignore case.
10457
10458 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10459 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10460 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10461 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10462 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10463 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10464 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10465
10466 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10467 the same format that was used in the file before.
10468
10469 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10470 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10471
10472 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10473 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10474 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10475
10476 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10477 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10478 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10479 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10480 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10481 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10482 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10483
10484 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10485 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10486 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10487 format. You can now customize these variables.
10488
10489 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10490 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10491 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10492 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10493
10494 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10495 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10496 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10497
10498 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10499 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10500 doesn't have any effect.
10501
10502 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10503 not one per buffer.
10504
10505 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10506 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10507 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10508
10509 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10510 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10511 `auto-show-mode' command.
10512
10513 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10514 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10515 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10516 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10517 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10518
10519 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10520 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10521
10522 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10523 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10524 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10525
10526 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10527 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10528 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10529 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10530
10531 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10532
10533 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10534 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10535 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10536 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10537 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10538
10539 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10540 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10541
10542 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10543 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10544 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10545 `?' on other systems.
10546
10547 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10548 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10549 Unix.
10550
10551 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10552 current codepage when it starts.
10553
10554 ** Mail changes
10555
10556 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10557 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10558 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10559 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10560 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10561 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10562 latin-1:
10563
10564 MIME-version: 1.0
10565 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10566 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10567
10568 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10569 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10570 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10571 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10572 buffer-file-coding-system.
10573
10574 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10575 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10576 mail.
10577
10578 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10579 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10580 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10581 list of possible coding systems.
10582
10583 ** CC Mode changes
10584
10585 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10586 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10587 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10588 docstring for details.
10589
10590 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10591 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10592 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10593 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10594 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10595
10596 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10597 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10598
10599 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10600 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10601
10602 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10603 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10604 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10605 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10606 anonymous classes.
10607
10608 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10609 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10610
10611 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10612 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10613 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10614 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10615
10616 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10617 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10618 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10619 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10620 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10621
10622 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10623
10624 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10625
10626 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10627 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10628
10629 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10630
10631 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10632 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10633 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10634 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10635 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10636
10637 ** Gnus changes.
10638
10639 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10640 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10641 Gnus manual for the full story.
10642
10643 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10644 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10645 group, which is created automatically.
10646
10647 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10648 values.
10649
10650 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10651
10652 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10653 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10654
10655 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10656 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10657
10658 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10659
10660 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10661 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10662
10663 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10664
10665 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10666 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10667
10668 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10669 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10670
10671 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10672 control over simplification.
10673
10674 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10675
10676 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10677 limit.
10678
10679 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10680
10681 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10682
10683 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10684 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10685 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10686
10687 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10688 `a' forces normal posting method.
10689
10690 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10691 -- `W d'.
10692
10693 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10694 to a non-nil value.
10695
10696 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10697 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10698
10699 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10700 has been added.
10701
10702 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10703
10704 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10705
10706 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10707 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10708
10709 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10710 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10711
10712 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10713
10714 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10715 been added.
10716
10717 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10718 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10719
10720 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10721 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10722
10723 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10724
10725 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10726
10727 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10728
10729 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10730
10731 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10732 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10733 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10734
10735 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10736 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10737 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10738 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10739 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10740
10741 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10742 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10743 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10744 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10745
10746 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10747 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10748 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10749 mismatch.
10750
10751 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10752
10753 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10754 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10755
10756 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10757 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10758 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10759 removed from the label.
10760
10761 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10762 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10763
10764 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10765 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10766
10767 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10768 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10769 expressions.
10770
10771 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10772
10773 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10774
10775 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10776 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10777
10778 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10779 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10780 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10781
10782 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10783 changes with a special face.
10784
10785 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10786 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10787 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10788 \f
10789 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10790
10791 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10792 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10793 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10794 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10795 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10796
10797 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10798 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10799 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10800
10801 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10802 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10803 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10804 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10805 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10806 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10807 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10808 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10809 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10810
10811 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10812 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10813 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10814 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10815 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10816 program.
10817
10818 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10819 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10820 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10821 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10822 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10823 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10824
10825 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10826 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10827 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10828 was not documented clearly before.
10829
10830 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10831 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10832 \f
10833 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10834
10835 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10836 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10837 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10838 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10839
10840 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10841 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10842 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10843
10844 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10845
10846 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10847 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10848
10849 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10850 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10851 integers.
10852
10853 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10854 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10855 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10856 file names and attributes are returned.
10857
10858 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10859 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10860 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10861 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10862 returns the result.
10863
10864 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10865 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10866
10867 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10868
10869 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10870 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10871 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10872 optionally.
10873
10874 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10875 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10876
10877 **
10878 The new function process-running-child-p
10879 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10880 terminal to its own child process.
10881
10882 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10883 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10884 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10885 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10886
10887 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10888 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10889
10890 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10891 :included is an alias for :visible.
10892
10893 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10894 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10895 to move or copy menu entries.
10896
10897 ** Multibyte editing changes
10898
10899 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10900 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10901 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10902 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10903 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10904 (setq char (sref str idx)
10905 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10906 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10907
10908 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10909 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10910 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10911
10912 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10913 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10914 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10915
10916 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10917
10918 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10919 across the boundary.
10920
10921 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10922 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10923 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10924 contains 8-bit characters.
10925 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10926 contains invalid characters.
10927
10928 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10929 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10930 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10931 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10932 way.
10933
10934 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10935 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10936 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10937 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10938
10939 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10940 compose Thai characters in a string.
10941
10942 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10943 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10944 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10945 menus should always use the third argument.
10946
10947 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10948 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10949 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10950 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10951
10952 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10953 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10954 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10955 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10956
10957 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10958 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10959 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10960 echo area contents.
10961
10962 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10963
10964 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10965 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10966 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10967
10968 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10969 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10970 means to clear out that attribute.
10971
10972 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10973 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10974
10975 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10976 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10977 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10978 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10979
10980 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10981 the gap of the current buffer.
10982
10983 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10984 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10985 current buffer.
10986
10987 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10988 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10989 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10990 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10991 \f
10992 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10993
10994 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10995 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10996 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10997 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10998 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10999
11000 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
11001 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
11002 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
11003 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
11004 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
11005
11006 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
11007 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
11008 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
11009
11010 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
11011 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
11012 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
11013 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
11014 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
11015 results.
11016
11017 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
11018 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
11019 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
11020 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
11021 \f
11022 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
11023
11024 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
11025 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
11026 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
11027 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
11028
11029 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
11030 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
11031 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
11032 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
11033 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
11034 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
11035 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
11036 region.
11037
11038 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
11039 selective undo.
11040
11041 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
11042 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
11043 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
11044 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
11045 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
11046
11047 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
11048 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
11049 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
11050 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
11051
11052 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
11053 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
11054 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
11055 something that most users not do.
11056
11057 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
11058 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
11059 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
11060 applications.
11061
11062 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
11063 pasting operations.
11064
11065 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
11066 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
11067 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
11068 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
11069 `ps-printer-name'.
11070
11071 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
11072 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
11073 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
11074 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
11075 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
11076 hits a new word.
11077
11078 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11079 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11080 to be confused by TeX commands.
11081
11082 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11083 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11084 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11085 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11086
11087 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11088 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11089 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11090 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11091 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11092
11093 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11094 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11095
11096 ** Changes in input method usage.
11097
11098 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11099 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11100 respectively.
11101
11102 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11103
11104 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11105 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11106
11107 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11108 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11109
11110 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11111
11112 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11113
11114 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11115 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11116
11117 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11118 given in the following case:
11119 o When you are using a complex input method.
11120 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11121
11122 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11123 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11124 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11125 setting it to t is helpful.
11126
11127 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11128
11129 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11130 keys:
11131 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11132 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11133 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11134 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11135 environment.
11136
11137 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11138 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11139 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11140 get
11141
11142 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11143
11144 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11145
11146 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11147 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11148
11149 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11150 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11151 its owner and group.
11152
11153 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11154 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11155
11156 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11157 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11158
11159 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11160 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11161 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11162 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11163
11164 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11165 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11166 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11167 for writing keyboard macros.
11168
11169 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11170 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11171 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11172 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11173 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11174 info.
11175
11176 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11177
11178 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11179 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11180 contents only.
11181
11182 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11183 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11184 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11185 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11186
11187 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11188 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11189 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11190
11191 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11192 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11193 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11194 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11195
11196 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11197 failure if the command produces no output.
11198
11199 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11200 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11201 the mouse.
11202
11203 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11204 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11205 function and variable names.
11206
11207 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11208 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11209 file-coding-system-alist.
11210
11211 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11212 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11213 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11214 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11215 according to the current fontset.
11216
11217 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11218
11219 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11220 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11221 nonascii-insert-offset.
11222
11223 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11224 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11225 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11226 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11227
11228 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11229 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11230
11231 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11232 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11233
11234 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11235 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11236 command keys.
11237
11238 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11239 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11240
11241 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11242 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11243 all variables that have documentation.
11244
11245 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11246 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11247 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11248 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11249 it should show; the default is 20.
11250
11251 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11252 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11253 of your input.
11254
11255 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11256 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11257 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11258 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11259 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11260 Newly added options are included as well.
11261
11262 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11263 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11264 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11265
11266 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11267 Customize menu.
11268
11269 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11270 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11271
11272 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11273 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11274 invoked.
11275
11276 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11277 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11278 The default is 1.
11279
11280 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11281 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11282 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11283 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11284 sensibly.
11285
11286 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11287
11288 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11289 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11290 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11291
11292 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11293 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11294 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11295 every night.
11296
11297 ** Desktop changes
11298
11299 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11300 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11301
11302 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11303 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11304
11305 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11306 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11307
11308 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11309 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11310 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11311 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11312 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11313 made invisible again.
11314
11315 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11316
11317 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11318 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11319 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11320 toggle.
11321
11322 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11323 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11324 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11325 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11326 rmail-default-body-file.
11327
11328 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11329 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11330 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11331
11332 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11333 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11334 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11335
11336 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11337 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11338 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11339 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11340 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11341 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11342
11343 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11344 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11345 provided by feedmail are:
11346
11347 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11348 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11349 there is also a queue for draft messages
11350
11351 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11352 be prompted for confirmation
11353
11354 **** does smart filling of address headers
11355
11356 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11357 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11358 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11359
11360 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11361 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11362 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11363 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11364
11365 ** Dired changes
11366
11367 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11368 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11369
11370 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11371 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11372
11373 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11374 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11375 for a specified regexp.
11376
11377 ** VC Changes
11378
11379 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11380 conveniently.
11381
11382 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11383 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11384 Dired.
11385
11386 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11387 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11388 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11389 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11390
11391 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11392 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11393 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11394 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11395 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11396
11397 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11398 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11399 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11400 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11401 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11402
11403 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11404 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11405 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11406 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11407
11408 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11409 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11410 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11411
11412 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11413 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11414 session to resolve them.
11415
11416 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11417 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11418 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11419 uses as well).
11420
11421 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11422 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11423 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11424 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11425 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11426 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11427 using ediff.
11428
11429 ** Changes in Font Lock
11430
11431 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11432 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11433 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11434 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11435 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11436
11437 ** Frame name display changes
11438
11439 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11440 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11441 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11442 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11443
11444 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11445 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11446 menu.
11447
11448 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11449
11450 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11451 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11452 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11453
11454 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11455
11456 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11457 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11458 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11459
11460 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11461 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11462 the following line.
11463
11464 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11465 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11466 previously sent input.
11467
11468 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11469 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11470 as the search string.
11471
11472 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11473 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11474
11475 ** C mode changes
11476
11477 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11478 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11479 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11480 definition.
11481
11482 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11483 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11484 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11485 style is still the default however.
11486
11487 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11488
11489 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11490 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11491 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11492
11493 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11494 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11495
11496 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11497 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11498
11499 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11500 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11501
11502 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11503 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11504
11505 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11506 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11507 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11508 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11509
11510 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11511
11512 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11513 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11514 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11515
11516 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11517 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11518 expanding dynamically.
11519
11520 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11521 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11522
11523 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11524 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11525 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11526 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11527
11528 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11529
11530 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11531
11532 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11533 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11534 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11535 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11536 against the first word in the title.
11537
11538 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11539 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11540 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11541 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11542 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11543 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11544
11545 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11546 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11547 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11548 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11549
11550 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11551
11552 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11553 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11554 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11555 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11556 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11557 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11558
11559 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11560 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11561
11562 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11563 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11564 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11565
11566 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11567 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11568
11569 ** Ispell changes.
11570
11571 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11572 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11573 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11574
11575 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11576 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11577 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11578 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11579 include:
11580
11581 o URLs are automatically skipped
11582 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11583
11584 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11585
11586 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11587
11588 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11589 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11590 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11591 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11592
11593 *** New recursive parser.
11594
11595 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11596 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11597 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11598
11599 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11600
11601 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11602 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11603 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11604
11605 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11606
11607 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11608
11609 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11610
11611 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11612
11613 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11614
11615 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11616 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11617
11618 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11619
11620 *** References to external documents.
11621
11622 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11623 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11624 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11625 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11626 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11627 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11628 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11629
11630 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11631
11632 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11633 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11634
11635 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11636 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11637
11638 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11639
11640 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11641 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11642
11643 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11644
11645 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11646 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11647 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11648 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11649 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11650 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11651 more.
11652
11653 *** Support for the varioref package
11654
11655 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11656
11657 *** New hooks
11658
11659 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11660 and citations are created. These hooks are
11661 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11662 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11663
11664 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11665
11666 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11667 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11668
11669 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11670
11671 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11672 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11673 fontified, use
11674
11675 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11676
11677 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11678 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11679 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11680 directories that contain the same file name.
11681
11682 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11683 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11684 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11685 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11686 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11687 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11688 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11689 directory.
11690
11691 ** New modes and packages
11692
11693 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11694 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11695 it, but some do not.
11696
11697 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11698 code.
11699
11700 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11701 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11702 around in a buffer.
11703
11704 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11705
11706 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11707 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11708 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11709 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11710
11711 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11712 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11713 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11714
11715 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11716 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11717 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11718 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11719 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11720 the like.
11721
11722 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11723 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11724
11725 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11726 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11727 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11728 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11729
11730 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11731
11732 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11733 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11734 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11735 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11736 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11737 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11738 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11739 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11740 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11741 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11742 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11743
11744 Platform-specific modes:
11745
11746 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11747 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11748 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11749 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11750 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11751 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11752 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11753 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11754 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11755 \f
11756 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11757
11758 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11759 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11760 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11761 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11762
11763 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11764 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11765 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11766
11767 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11768 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11769 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11770 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11771
11772 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11773 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11774 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11775 environment.
11776
11777 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11778 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11779 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11780 current input method for reading this one event.
11781
11782 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11783 now control whether to output certain characters as
11784 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11785 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11786 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11787 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11788 \f
11789 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11790
11791 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11792 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11793
11794 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11795 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11796 always increases point by 1.
11797
11798 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11799 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11800
11801 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11802
11803 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11804 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11805 default value changed. For example,
11806
11807 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11808 :type 'integer
11809 :group 'foo
11810 :version "20.3")
11811
11812 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11813 :version "20.3")
11814
11815 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11816 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11817 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11818 `:version' in the top level group.
11819
11820 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11821
11822 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11823 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11824
11825 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11826 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11827 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11828 to themselves.
11829
11830 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11831 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11832 values whatever.
11833
11834 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11835 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11836 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11837
11838 ** Frame-local variables.
11839
11840 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11841 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11842 local bindings for that variable.
11843
11844 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11845 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11846 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11847 parameter name.
11848
11849 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11850 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11851 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11852 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11853
11854 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11855 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11856 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11857 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11858
11859 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11860 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11861 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11862 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11863 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11864
11865 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11866 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11867 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11868 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11869
11870 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11871 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11872
11873 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11874 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11875 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11876
11877 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11878 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11879 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11880 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11881
11882 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11883 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11884 empty input.
11885
11886 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11887 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11888 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11889 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11890 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11891
11892 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11893 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11894 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11895 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11896
11897 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11898 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11899 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11900 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11901 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11902
11903 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11904 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11905 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11906 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11907
11908 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11909 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11910 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11911
11912 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11913 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11914 was directed to display this buffer.
11915
11916 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11917 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11918 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11919 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11920 set-window-configuration.
11921
11922 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11923 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11924 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11925 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11926
11927 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11928 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11929 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11930
11931 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11932 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11933 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11934
11935 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11936 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11937
11938 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11939 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11940
11941 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11942 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11943 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11944
11945 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11946 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11947 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11948 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11949
11950 ** Menu changes
11951
11952 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11953 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11954 better supported.
11955
11956 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11957 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11958 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11959 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11960 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11961
11962 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11963
11964 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11965 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11966 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11967 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11968
11969 The format is:
11970 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11971 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11972 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11973 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11974 The supported properties include
11975
11976 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11977 item is enabled.
11978 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11979 item should appear in the menu.
11980 :filter FILTER-FN
11981 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11982 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11983 It should return a binding to use instead.
11984 :keys DESCRIPTION
11985 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11986 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11987 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11988 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11989 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11990 keyboard binding.
11991 :key-sequence nil
11992 This means that the command normally has no
11993 keyboard equivalent.
11994 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11995 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11996 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11997 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11998 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11999
12000 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
12001 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
12002
12003 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
12004
12005 ** New event types
12006
12007 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
12008 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
12009 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
12010 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
12011
12012 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
12013
12014 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12015 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
12016 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
12017 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
12018 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
12019 forward, away from the user.
12020
12021 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12022
12023 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
12024 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
12025 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
12026 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
12027 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
12028
12029 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
12030
12031 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12032 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
12033 that were dragged and dropped.
12034
12035 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12036
12037 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
12038
12039 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
12040 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
12041 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
12042
12043 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
12044 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
12045 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
12046
12047 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
12048 in Emacs 19 and before.
12049
12050 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
12051 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
12052
12053 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
12054 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
12055 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
12056 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
12057
12058 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
12059 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
12060 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
12061 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
12062 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
12063
12064 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
12065 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
12066 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
12067 consistent with the new representation.
12068
12069 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
12070 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
12071 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
12072 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12073
12074 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
12075 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
12076 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
12077
12078 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12079 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12080 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12081
12082 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12083 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12084 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12085
12086 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12087 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12088
12089 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12090 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12091
12092 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12093 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12094 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12095 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12096
12097 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12098 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12099
12100 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12101 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12102 buffer or string being searched.
12103
12104 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12105 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12106 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12107 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12108 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12109 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12110 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12111
12112 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12113
12114 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12115 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12116 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12117 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12118 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12119 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12120 define-coding-system-alias.
12121
12122 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12123 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12124 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12125 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12126 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12127 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12128 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12129 `iso-8859-1'.
12130
12131 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12132 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12133 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12134 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12135
12136 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12137 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12138 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12139 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12140
12141 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12142 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12143 This function requires a user interaction.
12144
12145 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12146 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12147 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12148 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12149 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12150 select-safe-coding-system.
12151
12152 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12153 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12154 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12155 was done.
12156
12157 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12158 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12159 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12160
12161 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12162 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12163 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12164 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12165
12166 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12167 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12168 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12169 converted.
12170
12171 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12172 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12173
12174 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12175 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12176 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12177 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12178 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12179 range of characters.
12180
12181 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12182 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12183
12184 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12185 in the current buffer at position POS.
12186
12187 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12188 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12189 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12190 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12191 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12192 binding input-method-function to nil.
12193
12194 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12195 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12196 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12197 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12198 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12199
12200 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12201 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12202
12203 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12204 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12205
12206 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12207 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12208 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12209 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12210 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12211 \f
12212 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12213
12214 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12215 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12216 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12217 tree structure.
12218
12219 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12220 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12221
12222 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12223 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12224 in your .emacs file.)
12225
12226 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12227 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12228
12229 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12230 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12231
12232 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12233 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12234 kills the region.
12235
12236 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12237 delete the character before point, as usual.
12238
12239 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12240 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12241 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12242
12243 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12244 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12245 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12246 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12247 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12248 past.)
12249
12250 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12251 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12252 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12253 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12254 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12255
12256 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12257 and is an alias for it.
12258
12259 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12260 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12261
12262 ** Scrolling changes
12263
12264 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12265 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12266
12267 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12268 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12269 where it started.
12270
12271 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12272 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12273 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12274 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12275
12276 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12277 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12278 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12279 recenters the window.
12280
12281 ** International character set support (MULE)
12282
12283 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12284 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12285 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12286 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12287 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12288 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12289
12290 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12291 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12292 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12293 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12294 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12295
12296 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12297 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12298 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12299 language, to make it possible to type them.
12300
12301 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12302 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12303
12304 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12305 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12306
12307 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12308
12309 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12310
12311 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12312 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12313 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12314 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12315 characters for their work until they want to change.
12316
12317 *** Input methods
12318
12319 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12320 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12321 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12322 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12323 support several input methods.
12324
12325 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12326 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12327 work.
12328
12329 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12330 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12331 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12332 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12333 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12334 letter.
12335
12336 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12337 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12338 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12339 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12340 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12341
12342 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12343 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12344 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12345 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12346
12347 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12348 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12349 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12350 the first guess is wrong.
12351
12352 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12353 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12354
12355 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12356 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12357 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12358 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12359
12360 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12361 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12362 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12363 translate automatically to and from either one.
12364
12365 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12366
12367 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12368 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12369 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12370 what you want.
12371
12372 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12373 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12374 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12375 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12376
12377 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12378 character conversion as well.
12379
12380 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12381
12382 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12383 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12384 requires using many fonts.
12385
12386 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12387 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12388
12389 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12390 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12391 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12392 you would use a font.
12393
12394 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12395 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12396 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12397
12398 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12399 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12400 characters).
12401
12402 *** Defining fontsets.
12403
12404 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12405 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12406 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12407
12408 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12409 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12410 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12411 standard fontset are created automatically.
12412
12413 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12414 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12415 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12416 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12417 name is `fontset-startup'.
12418
12419 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12420 The resource value should have this form:
12421 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12422 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12423 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12424 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12425 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12426 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12427 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12428 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12429 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12430
12431 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12432 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12433 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12434
12435 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12436 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12437 following resource,
12438 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12439 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12440 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12441 Here is the substitution rule:
12442 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12443 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12444 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12445 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12446 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12447
12448 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12449 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12450 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12451
12452 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12453 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12454 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12455 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12456 fontsets.
12457
12458 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12459 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12460
12461 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12462 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12463 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12464 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12465 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12466 system for new files that you create.
12467
12468 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12469 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12470 whole Emacs session.
12471
12472 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12473 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12474 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12475
12476 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12477 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12478 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12479 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12480 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12481
12482 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12483 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12484 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12485 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12486 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12487
12488 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12489 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12490
12491 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12492 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12493
12494 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12495 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12496
12497 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12498 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12499 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12500 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12501 of the file.
12502
12503 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12504 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12505 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12506 translated into that character code.
12507
12508 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12509 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12510
12511 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12512
12513 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12514 the coding system for keyboard input.
12515
12516 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12517 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12518 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12519
12520 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12521
12522 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12523 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12524 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12525 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12526 designed to work with terminals.
12527
12528 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12529 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12530 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12531 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12532 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12533 in the corresponding buffer.
12534
12535 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12536
12537 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12538 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12539 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12540
12541 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12542 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12543 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12544 want to use.
12545
12546 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12547 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12548
12549 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12550 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12551 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12552 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12553
12554 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12555 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12556 related information.
12557
12558 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12559 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12560 scripts.
12561
12562 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12563 information about the support for a particular language.
12564 You specify the language as an argument.
12565
12566 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12567 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12568 first dash.
12569
12570 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12571 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12572 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12573 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12574
12575 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12576 B big5 (Chinese)
12577 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12578 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12579 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12580 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12581 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12582 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12583 K euc-korea (Korean)
12584 R koi8 (Russian)
12585 Q tibetan
12586 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12587 T lao
12588 T tis620 (Thai)
12589 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12590 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12591 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12592 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12593 z hz (Chinese)
12594
12595 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12596 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12597 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12598 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12599
12600 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12601 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12602
12603 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12604 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12605 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12606 Rmail files themselves.
12607
12608 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12609 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12610
12611 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12612 for sending mail:
12613
12614 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12615 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12616 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12617 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12618 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12619
12620 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12621 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12622 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12623 translations.
12624
12625 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12626 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12627 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12628 without any conversion.
12629
12630 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12631 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12632 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12633 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12634
12635 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12636 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12637
12638 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12639 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12640
12641 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12642 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12643
12644 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12645 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12646 in the buffer before point.
12647
12648 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12649 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12650 you are using.
12651
12652 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12653 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12654
12655 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12656
12657 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12658 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12659
12660 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12661 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12662 can become a bottleneck.
12663
12664 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12665 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12666 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12667 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12668 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12669 so useful that the change is worth while.
12670
12671 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12672 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12673 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12674 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12675
12676 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12677 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12678 show-paren-mode.
12679
12680 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12681 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12682 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12683
12684 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12685 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12686 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12687
12688 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12689 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12690 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12691
12692 ** Changes in View mode.
12693
12694 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12695 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12696
12697 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12698 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12699
12700 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12701 previous state.
12702
12703 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12704 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12705
12706 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12707 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12708 not just the selected window.
12709
12710 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12711 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12712 turns View mode on or off.
12713
12714 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12715 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12716 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12717
12718 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12719 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12720
12721 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12722 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12723 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12724 which version to compare with.
12725
12726 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12727 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12728
12729 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12730 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12731 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12732 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12733
12734 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12735 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12736 blocks, all of them or none.
12737
12738 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12739 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12740 confirmation first.
12741
12742 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12743 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12744 However, the mode will not be changed if
12745 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12746 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12747 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12748 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12749
12750 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12751
12752 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12753 these commands do not change the major mode.
12754
12755 ** M-x occur changes.
12756
12757 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12758 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12759
12760 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12761 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12762 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12763
12764 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12765 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12766 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12767 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12768 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12769
12770 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12771 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12772 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12773 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12774
12775 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12776 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12777 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12778
12779 ** Outline mode changes.
12780
12781 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12782
12783 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12784
12785 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12786 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12787 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12788 was already active.
12789
12790 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12791 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12792 get confused by it.
12793
12794 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12795 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12796
12797 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12798
12799 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12800 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12801 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12802 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12803
12804 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12805 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12806 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12807
12808 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12809 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12810 values.
12811
12812 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12813 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12814 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12815 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12816
12817 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12818 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12819 can be. The default value is 30.
12820
12821 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12822
12823 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12824 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12825 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12826 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12827 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12828 behavior.
12829
12830 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12831 compose-mail-other-frame.
12832
12833 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12834 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12835 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12836 buffer that shows the original message.
12837
12838 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12839 with separator lines around the contents.
12840
12841 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12842 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12843 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12844 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12845
12846 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12847
12848 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12849 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12850 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12851 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12852
12853 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12854 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12855 /etc/passwd.
12856
12857 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12858 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12859 /etc/passwd.
12860
12861 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12862 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12863 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12864 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12865
12866 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12867 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12868 be taken to be magic.
12869
12870 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12871 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12872 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12873
12874 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12875 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12876
12877 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12878 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12879
12880 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12881
12882 new key dired.el binding old key
12883 ------- ---------------- -------
12884 * c dired-change-marks c
12885 * m dired-mark m
12886 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12887 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12888 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12889 * u dired-unmark u
12890 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12891 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12892 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12893 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12894 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12895 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12896
12897 ** Rmail changes.
12898
12899 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12900 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12901 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12902 each time you run it.
12903
12904 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12905 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12906
12907 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12908 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12909 means to move in the opposite direction.
12910
12911 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12912 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12913
12914 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12915 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12916 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12917 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12918 for output.
12919
12920 ** Gnus changes.
12921
12922 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12923
12924 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12925 Gnus.
12926
12927 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12928 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12929
12930 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12931 article mode line.
12932
12933 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12934
12935 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12936
12937 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12938
12939 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12940 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12941 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12942
12943 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12944
12945 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12946
12947 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12948 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12949
12950 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12951 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12952 used to pick articles.
12953
12954 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12955 another have been added.
12956
12957 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12958
12959 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12960 generating lines in buffers.
12961
12962 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12963 `C-M-_'.
12964
12965 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12966
12967 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12968
12969 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12970
12971 *** Scores can be decayed.
12972
12973 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12974
12975 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12976 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12977
12978 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12979 the native server.
12980
12981 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12982
12983 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12984 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12985
12986 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12987
12988 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12989 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12990
12991 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12992 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12993
12994 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12995 a group.
12996
12997 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12998 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12999
13000 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
13001
13002 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
13003
13004 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
13005
13006 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
13007
13008 Use the `Y c' command.
13009
13010 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
13011
13012 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
13013
13014 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
13015
13016 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
13017 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
13018
13019 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
13020
13021 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
13022
13023 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
13024 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
13025
13026 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
13027
13028 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
13029 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
13030 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
13031 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
13032 this issue.)
13033
13034 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
13035 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
13036 particular news group. This can be done by:
13037
13038 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
13039
13040 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
13041 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
13042 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
13043 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
13044 for reading and posting).
13045
13046 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
13047 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
13048 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
13049 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
13050 there.
13051
13052 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
13053 default. Here are some of these default settings:
13054
13055 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
13056 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
13057 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
13058 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
13059 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
13060
13061 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
13062 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
13063
13064 ** CC mode changes.
13065
13066 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
13067 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
13068 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
13069 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
13070 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
13071 loaded.
13072
13073 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
13074 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
13075 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
13076 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
13077 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
13078 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13079
13080 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13081 of the current buffer.
13082
13083 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13084 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13085 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13086
13087 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13088 style that the Python developers like.
13089
13090 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13091 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13092 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13093
13094 ** VC Changes [new]
13095
13096 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13097 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13098 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13099
13100 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13101 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13102 developers.
13103
13104 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13105 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13106
13107 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13108 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13109 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13110 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13111
13112 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13113 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13114
13115 ** Calendar changes.
13116
13117 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13118 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13119 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13120 following/previous years.
13121
13122 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13123 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13124 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13125 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13126 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13127 supposed attribute of God.
13128
13129 ** ps-print changes
13130
13131 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13132 layout.
13133
13134 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13135
13136 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13137 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13138 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13139 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13140
13141 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13142 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13143 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13144
13145 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13146 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13147
13148 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13149 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13150 printing for your printer.
13151
13152 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13153 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13154
13155 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13156 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13157
13158 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13159 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13160 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13161 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13162 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13163 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13164 The default value is nil.
13165
13166 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13167 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13168
13169 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13170 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13171 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13172 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13173 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13174 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13175 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13176
13177 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13178 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13179
13180 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13181 The default is 0 ("black").
13182
13183 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13184 The default is 0 ("black").
13185
13186 border-width Specify the border width.
13187 The default is 0.4.
13188
13189 Any other property is ignored.
13190
13191 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13192 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13193 documentation).
13194
13195 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13196 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13197 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13198 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13199 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13200 controlling headers.
13201
13202 *** Color management (subgroup)
13203
13204 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13205 color.
13206
13207 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13208
13209 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13210 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13211 background should be used. Valid values are:
13212
13213 t always use face background color.
13214 nil never use face background color.
13215 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13216
13217 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13218
13219 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13220 sheet of paper.
13221
13222 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13223 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13224
13225 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13226 each page.
13227
13228 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13229 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13230 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13231
13232 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13233 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13234 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13235
13236 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13237 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13238 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13239
13240 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13241 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13242 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13243
13244 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13245 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13246 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13247
13248 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13249
13250 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13251
13252 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13253 RGB color.
13254
13255 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13256 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13257 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13258
13259 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13260 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13261 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13262 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13263 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13264 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13265 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13266 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13267 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13268 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13269 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13270 10 + 10 +
13271 11 + 11 +
13272 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13273 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13274 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13275 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13276 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13277 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13278 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13279 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13280 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13281 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13282 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13283 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13284 22 + 22 +
13285 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13286
13287 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13288
13289
13290 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13291
13292 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13293 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13294 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13295 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13296 to "-P".
13297
13298 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13299 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13300 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13301
13302 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13303 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13304 do so.
13305
13306 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13307
13308 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13309 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13310 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13311 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13312 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13313 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13314 `setpagedevice'.
13315
13316 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13317 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13318 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13319
13320 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13321 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13322 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13323 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13324 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13325 its TO, are ignored.
13326
13327 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13328 pages. Valid values are:
13329
13330 nil print all pages.
13331
13332 `even-page' print only even pages.
13333
13334 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13335
13336 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13337 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13338 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13339 print only the even sheet of paper.
13340
13341 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13342 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13343 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13344 only the odd sheet of paper.
13345
13346 Any other value is treated as nil.
13347
13348 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13349 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13350 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13351
13352 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13353
13354 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13355 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13356
13357 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13358 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13359 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13360 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13361 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13362 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13363 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13364
13365 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13366 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13367 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13368 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13369 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13370 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13371 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13372
13373 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13374
13375 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13376 messages should be sent.
13377
13378 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13379 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13380 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13381
13382 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13383
13384 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13385 points for line numbers.
13386
13387 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13388 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13389
13390 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13391 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13392 to 2, the printing will look like:
13393
13394 1 one line
13395 one line
13396 3 one line
13397 one line
13398 5 one line
13399 one line
13400 ...
13401
13402 Valid values are:
13403
13404 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13405 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13406 is used.
13407
13408 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13409 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13410
13411 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13412
13413 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13414 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13415 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13416 3, the output will look like:
13417
13418 one line
13419 one line
13420 3 one line
13421 one line
13422 one line
13423 6 one line
13424 one line
13425 one line
13426 9 one line
13427 one line
13428 ...
13429
13430 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13431 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13432
13433 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13434 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13435 `ps-font-size').
13436
13437 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13438 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13439 `ps-font-size').
13440
13441 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13442
13443 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13444 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13445
13446 ** hideshow changes.
13447
13448 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13449 C++, ; for lisp).
13450
13451 *** Support for java-mode added.
13452
13453 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13454 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13455
13456 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13457 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13458 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13459
13460 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13461 robust and a lot faster.
13462
13463 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13464
13465 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13466 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13467 documentation for more details.
13468
13469 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13470
13471 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13472 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13473 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13474 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13475 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13476
13477 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13478 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13479 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13480 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13481
13482 ** Font Lock mode
13483
13484 *** Custom support
13485
13486 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13487 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13488 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13489 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13490 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13491 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13492
13493 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13494
13495 *** Maximum decoration
13496
13497 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13498 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13499 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13500 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13501 to get the old behavior.
13502
13503 *** New support
13504
13505 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13506
13507 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13508 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13509
13510 *** Configurable support
13511
13512 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13513 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13514 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13515 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13516 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13517 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13518 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13519
13520 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13521 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13522 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13523
13524 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13525
13526 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13527 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13528 for any mode.
13529
13530 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13531
13532 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13533
13534 in your ~/.emacs.
13535
13536 *** New faces
13537
13538 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13539 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13540 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13541 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13542
13543 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13544
13545 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13546 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13547 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13548
13549 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13550
13551 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13552 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13553 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13554 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13555 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13556 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13557 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13558
13559 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13560 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13561 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13562 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13563 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13564 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13565
13566 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13567
13568 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13569 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13570 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13571 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13572
13573 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13574 settings.
13575
13576 ** Ada mode changes.
13577
13578 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13579 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13580 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13581 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13582 stubs.
13583
13584 *** There are two new commands:
13585 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13586 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13587
13588 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13589 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13590 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13591
13592 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13593 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13594 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13595
13596 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13597 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13598 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13599 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13600
13601 ** Scheme mode changes.
13602
13603 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13604 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13605 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13606 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13607 have any effect.
13608
13609 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13610 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13611 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13612 variables as buffer-local variables.
13613
13614 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13615 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13616
13617 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13618
13619 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13620 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13621 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13622 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13623
13624 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13625 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13626 buffer in Emacs.
13627
13628 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13629 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13630 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13631 option takes precedence.
13632
13633 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13634 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13635 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13636
13637 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13638 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13639 the current defun.
13640
13641 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13642 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13643
13644 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13645 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13646 necessary).
13647
13648 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13649 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13650 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13651 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13652 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13653 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13654
13655 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13656 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13657 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13658 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13659
13660 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13661 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13662 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13663 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13664 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13665
13666 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13667 since it applies only to the current frame.
13668
13669 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13670 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13671 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13672
13673 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13674 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13675 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13676 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13677 instead of just the file you are editing.
13678
13679 ** RefTeX mode
13680
13681 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13682 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13683 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13684 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13685 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13686
13687 C-c ( reftex-label
13688 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13689 knows which kind of label is needed.
13690
13691 C-c ) reftex-reference
13692 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13693 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13694
13695 C-c [ reftex-citation
13696 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13697 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13698
13699 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13700 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13701
13702 C-c = reftex-toc
13703 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13704 can quickly jump to every section.
13705
13706 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13707 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13708 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13709 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13710 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13711
13712 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13713
13714 *** Info documentation is now available.
13715
13716 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13717 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13718
13719 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13720 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13721
13722 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13723 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13724
13725 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13726 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13727 appropriate functions.
13728
13729 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13730 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13731
13732 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13733 been cleaned.
13734
13735 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13736 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13737
13738 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13739 shall be delimited.
13740
13741 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13742 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13743 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13744
13745 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13746 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13747 prefixed with `ALT'.
13748
13749 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13750 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13751 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13752 documentation).
13753
13754 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13755 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13756 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13757
13758 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13759 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13760
13761 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13762 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13763 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13764
13765 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13766
13767 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13768
13769 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13770 from alien sources.
13771
13772 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13773 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13774 crossref entries.
13775
13776 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13777 region.
13778
13779 *** Added support for imenu.
13780
13781 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13782 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13783 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13784 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13785
13786 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13787 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13788
13789 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13790
13791 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13792
13793 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13794 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13795 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13796 as an argument.
13797
13798 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13799 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13800
13801 ** browse-url changes
13802
13803 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13804 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13805 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13806 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13807 customization variables.
13808
13809 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13810
13811 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13812 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13813 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13814
13815 ** Changes in Ediff
13816
13817 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13818 pops up the Info file for this command.
13819
13820 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13821 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13822 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13823 directories).
13824
13825 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13826 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13827 files in the same directory.
13828
13829 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13830 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13831 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13832
13833 ** Changes in Viper
13834
13835 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13836 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13837 instead of vip-.
13838 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13839 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13840 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13841 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13842 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13843 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13844 color when Viper is in insert state.
13845 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13846 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13847 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13848
13849 ** Etags changes.
13850
13851 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13852 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13853 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13854 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13855 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13856
13857 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13858
13859 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13860 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13861
13862 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13863 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13864 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13865
13866 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13867 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13868 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13869 methods and protocols.
13870
13871 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13872 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13873 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13874 paragraph name.
13875
13876 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13877 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13878 at least M times and as many as N times.
13879
13880 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13881 in files has changed slightly.
13882
13883 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13884 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13885 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13886 with old time-stamp-format values.
13887
13888 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13889 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13890 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13891 reasons.
13892
13893 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13894 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13895 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13896 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13897 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13898 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13899
13900 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13901 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13902 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13903
13904 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13905 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13906 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13907 recommended now will continue to work then.
13908
13909 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13910 details.
13911
13912 ** There are some additional major modes:
13913
13914 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13915 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13916 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13917
13918 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13919 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13920 into Emacs.
13921
13922 ** New Lisp packages include:
13923
13924 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13925
13926 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13927 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13928
13929 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13930
13931 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13932 in shell buffers.
13933
13934 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13935 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13936 and `elint-defun'.
13937
13938 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13939 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13940 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13941 strings or comments.
13942
13943 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13944 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13945 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13946 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13947 at these points.
13948
13949 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13950 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13951
13952 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13953 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13954
13955 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13956
13957 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13958 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13959
13960 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13961
13962 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13963
13964 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13965
13966 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13967 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13968
13969 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13970 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13971 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13972 original place after inserting the copy.
13973
13974 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13975 on the buffer.
13976
13977 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13978 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13979 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13980
13981 Enable mouse-drag with:
13982 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13983 -or-
13984 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13985
13986 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13987 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13988
13989 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13990 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13991
13992 *** ogonek
13993
13994 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13995 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13996 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13997 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13998 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13999 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
14000 instance) and vice versa.
14001
14002 To use this package load it using
14003 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
14004 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
14005 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
14006 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
14007 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
14008 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
14009
14010 *** Interface to ph.
14011
14012 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
14013
14014 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
14015 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
14016 these servers.
14017
14018 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
14019
14020 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
14021 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
14022 while the real cursor does not move.
14023
14024 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
14025 for visiting your favorite web sites.
14026
14027 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
14028 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
14029
14030 ** movemail change
14031
14032 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
14033 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
14034 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
14035 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
14036
14037 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
14038 \f
14039 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
14040
14041 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
14042
14043 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
14044 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
14045 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
14046 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
14047 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
14048
14049 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
14050 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
14051 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
14052 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
14053 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
14054 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
14055 \f
14056 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
14057
14058 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
14059 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
14060 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
14061 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
14062
14063 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
14064 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
14065
14066 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
14067 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
14068 "win".
14069
14070 ** Basic Lisp changes
14071
14072 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
14073 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
14074
14075 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
14076 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
14077 or by the user.
14078
14079 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14080
14081 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14082
14083 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14084 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14085
14086 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14087 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14088 its argument.
14089
14090 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14091
14092 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14093
14094 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14095
14096 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14097 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14098 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14099 `format' function.
14100
14101 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14102 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14103 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14104
14105 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14106 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14107 adding one of these suffixes.
14108
14109 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14110 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14111 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14112
14113 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14114 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14115
14116 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14117
14118 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14119 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14120
14121 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14122 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14123
14124 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14125
14126 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14127 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14128
14129 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14130 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14131 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14132 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14133
14134 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14135 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14136 of the last form.
14137
14138 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14139 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14140 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14141 as the last form.
14142
14143 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14144 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14145 matches.
14146
14147 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14148
14149 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14150 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14151 Then it returns that string.
14152
14153 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14154
14155 (with-output-to-string
14156 (princ "The buffer is ")
14157 (princ (buffer-name)))
14158
14159 returns "The buffer is foo".
14160
14161 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14162 is non-nil.
14163
14164 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14165 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14166 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14167
14168 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14169 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14170
14171 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14172 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14173 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14174 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14175 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14176 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14177
14178 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14179 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14180 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14181 characters".
14182
14183 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14184 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14185 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14186 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14187 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14188
14189 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14190 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14191 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14192 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14193
14194 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14195 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14196
14197 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14198
14199 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14200 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14201 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14202 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14203 guaranteed.
14204
14205 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14206 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14207 character).
14208
14209 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14210
14211 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14212 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14213 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14214 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14215 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14216
14217 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14218
14219 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14220 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14221 more than the number of characters.
14222
14223 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14224 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14225 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14226 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14227 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14228 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14229
14230 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14231 and returns a string containing those characters.
14232
14233 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14234 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14235 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14236 character, sref signals an error.
14237
14238 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14239 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14240 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14241
14242 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14243 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14244 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14245
14246 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14247 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14248 to a vector of the characters in it.
14249
14250 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14251 of a string. You call it as follows:
14252
14253 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14254
14255 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14256 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14257 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14258 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14259 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14260
14261 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14262 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14263
14264 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14265 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14266
14267 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14268 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14269 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14270 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14271
14272 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14273
14274 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14275
14276 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14277 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14278 are not included in the resulting value.
14279
14280 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14281 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14282 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14283 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14284
14285 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14286 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14287 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14288 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14289 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14290 column START-COLUMN.
14291
14292 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14293 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14294 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14295 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14296 changed text, before the change.
14297
14298 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14299 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14300 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14301
14302 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14303
14304 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14305
14306 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14307 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14308
14309 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14310 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14311 which identify the character within that character set.
14312
14313 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14314 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14315 opposite of split-char.
14316
14317 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14318 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14319
14320 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14321 of all the characters in a string.
14322
14323 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14324 and specifying coding systems.
14325
14326 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14327 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14328 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14329 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14330 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14331 as what to do about code conversion.)
14332
14333 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14334 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14335
14336 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14337 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14338 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14339
14340 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14341 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14342 to match against a file name.
14343
14344 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14345 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14346 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14347 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14348 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14349 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14350
14351 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14352 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14353
14354 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14355 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14356
14357 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14358 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14359 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14360 service names.
14361
14362 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14363 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14364 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14365 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14366 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14367 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14368
14369 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14370 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14371
14372 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14373 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14374 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14375 start the subprocess.
14376
14377 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14378 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14379 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14380 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14381 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14382
14383 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14384 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14385 subprocess.
14386
14387 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14388 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14389 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14390 connection permanently or until overridden.
14391
14392 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14393 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14394 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14395 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14396 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14397 system for one operation at a time.
14398
14399 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14400 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14401
14402 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14403 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14404 The value is a cons cell,
14405 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14406 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14407 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14408 input to the subprocess.
14409
14410 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14411 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14412
14413 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14414 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14415 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14416
14417 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14418 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14419 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14420 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14421 customization.
14422
14423 Thus, instead of writing
14424
14425 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14426 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14427
14428 you would now write this:
14429
14430 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14431 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14432 :type 'boolean
14433 :group foo)
14434
14435 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14436 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14437 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14438 for a description of them.
14439
14440 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14441 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14442
14443 (defgroup ispell nil
14444 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14445 :group 'processes)
14446
14447 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14448 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14449 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14450 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14451 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14452
14453 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14454 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14455 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14456 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14457 first-level subgroups.
14458
14459 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14460
14461 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14462 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14463
14464 ** easy-mmode
14465
14466 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14467 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14468 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14469 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14470 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14471 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14472
14473 ** Text property changes
14474
14475 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14476 text property.
14477
14478 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14479 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14480 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14481 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14482 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14483
14484 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14485 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14486 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14487 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14488
14489 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14490 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14491 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14492
14493 ** Changes in invisibility features
14494
14495 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14496 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14497 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14498 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14499 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14500 make the overlay visible.
14501
14502 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14503 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14504 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14505 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14506 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14507 t when it should hide it.
14508
14509 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14510
14511 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14512 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14513 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14514 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14515 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14516 Here is an example of how to do this:
14517
14518 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14519 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14520 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14521 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14522
14523 ...
14524 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14525
14526 ...
14527 ;; When done with the overlays:
14528 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14529 ;; Or respectively:
14530 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14531
14532 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14533
14534 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14535 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14536 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14537 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14538
14539 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14540 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14541 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14542
14543 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14544 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14545
14546 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14547 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14548
14549 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14550 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14551 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14552
14553 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14554 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14555 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14556 determine the syntax type of the character.
14557
14558 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14559 of the current buffer.
14560
14561 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14562 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14563 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14564
14565 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14566 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14567 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14568 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14569 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14570
14571 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14572 text property.
14573
14574 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14575 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14576 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14577
14578 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14579 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14580 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14581 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14582 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14583
14584 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14585 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14586 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14587
14588 ** Changes in face features
14589
14590 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14591 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14592
14593 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14594 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14595
14596 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14597 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14598
14599 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14600 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14601
14602 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14603 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14604 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14605 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14606 overlay property).
14607
14608 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14609 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14610
14611 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14612
14613 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14614 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14615 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14616 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14617
14618 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14619 begins with ~.
14620
14621 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14622 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14623
14624 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14625 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14626
14627 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14628 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14629
14630 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14631 character code conversion as well as other things.
14632
14633 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14634 (formerly it did not).
14635
14636 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14637 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14638
14639 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14640 instead of constant strings.
14641
14642 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14643 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14644 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14645
14646 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14647 in the same way as before.
14648
14649 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14650 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14651 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14652
14653 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14654 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14655 else, and returns nil.
14656
14657 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14658 directory cannot be listed.
14659
14660 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14661
14662 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14663 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14664 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14665 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14666 ways:
14667
14668 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14669 It is available through the history command M-n.
14670
14671 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14672 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14673 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14674 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14675 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14676
14677 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14678 argument in this way.
14679
14680 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14681 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14682 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14683
14684 ** Echo area features
14685
14686 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14687 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14688 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14689 after the echo area is cleared.
14690
14691 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14692 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14693
14694 ** Keyboard input features
14695
14696 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14697 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14698
14699 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14700 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14701 by keyboard macros.
14702
14703 ** Frame-related changes
14704
14705 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14706 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14707 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14708
14709 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14710 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14711 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14712
14713 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14714 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14715 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14716 in the selected frame.
14717
14718 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14719 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14720 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14721
14722 ** X Windows features
14723
14724 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14725 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14726 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14727
14728 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14729 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14730
14731 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14732 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14733 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14734
14735 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14736 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14737
14738 ** Subprocess features
14739
14740 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14741 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14742 automatically.
14743
14744 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14745 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14746
14747 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14748 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14749
14750 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14751 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14752
14753 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14754 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14755 goes after the other menu items.
14756
14757 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14758 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14759 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14760 are in use.
14761
14762 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14763 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14764
14765 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14766 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14767 form.
14768
14769 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14770 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14771 but its hook is still run.
14772
14773 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14774 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14775
14776 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14777 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14778 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14779
14780 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14781 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14782 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14783 warned.
14784
14785 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14786 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14787
14788 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14789 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14790 functions like display-time.
14791
14792 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14793 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14794
14795 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14796 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14797 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14798
14799 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14800 if there is an error in compilation.
14801
14802 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14803 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14804 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14805 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14806
14807 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14808 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14809 the *scratch* buffer.
14810
14811 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14812 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14813 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14814 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14815
14816 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14817 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14818 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14819
14820 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14821 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14822 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14823 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14824
14825 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14826 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14827 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14828
14829 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14830 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14831 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14832 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14833 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14834 files at all.
14835
14836 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14837 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14838 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14839 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14840
14841 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14842 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14843 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14844 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14845
14846 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14847
14848 ** imenu.el changes.
14849
14850 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14851 item from menu created by imenu.
14852
14853 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14854 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14855 select one of those items.
14856 \f
14857 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14858
14859 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14860 Copyright information:
14861
14862 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14863 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14864
14865 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14866 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14867 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14868 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14869
14870 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14871 of this document, or of portions of it,
14872 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14873 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14874 \f
14875 Local variables:
14876 mode: outline
14877 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14878 end:
14879
14880 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793